Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
elf32-ppc.c revision 1.8
      1  1.1  christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
      2  1.8  christos    Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      3  1.1  christos    Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
      4  1.1  christos 
      5  1.1  christos    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      6  1.1  christos 
      7  1.1  christos    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
      8  1.1  christos    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
      9  1.1  christos    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     10  1.1  christos    (at your option) any later version.
     11  1.1  christos 
     12  1.1  christos    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     13  1.1  christos    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     14  1.1  christos    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     15  1.1  christos    GNU General Public License for more details.
     16  1.1  christos 
     17  1.1  christos    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     18  1.1  christos    along with this program; if not, write to the
     19  1.1  christos    Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
     20  1.1  christos    Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     21  1.1  christos 
     22  1.1  christos 
     23  1.1  christos /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI.  The
     24  1.1  christos    information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI.  It includes
     25  1.1  christos    suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
     26  1.1  christos    information may also not match.  */
     27  1.1  christos 
     28  1.1  christos #include "sysdep.h"
     29  1.1  christos #include <stdarg.h>
     30  1.1  christos #include "bfd.h"
     31  1.1  christos #include "bfdlink.h"
     32  1.1  christos #include "libbfd.h"
     33  1.1  christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
     34  1.1  christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
     35  1.1  christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
     36  1.1  christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
     37  1.1  christos #include "dwarf2.h"
     38  1.7  christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
     39  1.1  christos 
     40  1.1  christos typedef enum split16_format_type
     41  1.1  christos {
     42  1.1  christos   split16a_type = 0,
     43  1.1  christos   split16d_type
     44  1.1  christos }
     45  1.1  christos split16_format_type;
     46  1.1  christos 
     47  1.1  christos /* RELA relocations are used here.  */
     48  1.1  christos 
     49  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
     50  1.1  christos   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     51  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
     52  1.1  christos   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     53  1.1  christos 
     54  1.1  christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs.  */
     55  1.1  christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
     56  1.1  christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions.  */
     57  1.1  christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
     58  1.1  christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA.  */
     59  1.1  christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
     60  1.1  christos 
     61  1.1  christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
     62  1.1  christos    section.  */
     63  1.1  christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
     64  1.1  christos 
     65  1.1  christos /* For old-style PLT.  */
     66  1.1  christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots).  */
     67  1.1  christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
     68  1.1  christos 
     69  1.1  christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt.  */
     70  1.1  christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
     71  1.8  christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h)					\
     72  1.8  christos   ((4*4									\
     73  1.8  christos     + (h != NULL							\
     74  1.8  christos        && h == htab->tls_get_addr					\
     75  1.8  christos        && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0)			\
     76  1.8  christos     + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1)				\
     77  1.8  christos    & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
     78  1.1  christos 
     79  1.1  christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker.  */
     80  1.1  christos 
     81  1.1  christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry.  */
     82  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
     83  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
     84  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     85  1.1  christos   {
     86  1.8  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0		 */
     87  1.8  christos     0x818c0000, /* lwz	   r12,0(r12)		 */
     88  1.8  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr   r12			 */
     89  1.8  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr				 */
     90  1.8  christos     0x39600000, /* li	   r11,0		 */
     91  1.8  christos     0x48000000, /* b	   14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
     92  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     93  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     94  1.1  christos   };
     95  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
     96  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     97  1.1  christos   {
     98  1.1  christos     0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
     99  1.1  christos     0x818c0000, /* lwz	 r12,0(r12) */
    100  1.1  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
    101  1.1  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
    102  1.1  christos     0x39600000, /* li	 r11,0 */
    103  1.1  christos     0x48000000, /* b	 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
    104  1.1  christos     0x60000000, /* nop */
    105  1.1  christos     0x60000000, /* nop */
    106  1.1  christos   };
    107  1.1  christos 
    108  1.1  christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry.  */
    109  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
    110  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
    111  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    112  1.1  christos   {
    113  1.8  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0	*/
    114  1.8  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi	   r12,r12,0	*/
    115  1.8  christos     0x800c0008, /* lwz	   r0,8(r12)	*/
    116  1.8  christos     0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr   r0		*/
    117  1.8  christos     0x818c0004, /* lwz	   r12,4(r12)	*/
    118  1.8  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr			*/
    119  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    120  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    121  1.1  christos   };
    122  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
    123  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    124  1.1  christos   {
    125  1.1  christos     0x819e0008, /* lwz	 r12,8(r30) */
    126  1.8  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12	    */
    127  1.1  christos     0x819e0004, /* lwz	 r12,4(r30) */
    128  1.8  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr		    */
    129  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    130  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    131  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    132  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    133  1.1  christos   };
    134  1.1  christos 
    135  1.1  christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
    136  1.1  christos    .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader.  */
    137  1.1  christos 
    138  1.1  christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
    139  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
    140  1.1  christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
    141  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
    142  1.8  christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
    143  1.1  christos    a shared library. */
    144  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
    145  1.1  christos 
    146  1.1  christos /* Some instructions.  */
    147  1.1  christos #define ADDIS_11_11	0x3d6b0000
    148  1.1  christos #define ADDIS_11_30	0x3d7e0000
    149  1.1  christos #define ADDIS_12_12	0x3d8c0000
    150  1.1  christos #define ADDI_11_11	0x396b0000
    151  1.1  christos #define ADD_0_11_11	0x7c0b5a14
    152  1.1  christos #define ADD_3_12_2	0x7c6c1214
    153  1.1  christos #define ADD_11_0_11	0x7d605a14
    154  1.1  christos #define B		0x48000000
    155  1.3  christos #define BA		0x48000002
    156  1.1  christos #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005
    157  1.1  christos #define BCTR		0x4e800420
    158  1.1  christos #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
    159  1.1  christos #define CMPWI_11_0	0x2c0b0000
    160  1.1  christos #define LIS_11		0x3d600000
    161  1.1  christos #define LIS_12		0x3d800000
    162  1.1  christos #define LWZU_0_12	0x840c0000
    163  1.1  christos #define LWZ_0_12	0x800c0000
    164  1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_3	0x81630000
    165  1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_11	0x816b0000
    166  1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_30	0x817e0000
    167  1.1  christos #define LWZ_12_3	0x81830000
    168  1.1  christos #define LWZ_12_12	0x818c0000
    169  1.1  christos #define MR_0_3		0x7c601b78
    170  1.1  christos #define MR_3_0		0x7c030378
    171  1.1  christos #define MFLR_0		0x7c0802a6
    172  1.1  christos #define MFLR_12		0x7d8802a6
    173  1.1  christos #define MTCTR_0		0x7c0903a6
    174  1.1  christos #define MTCTR_11	0x7d6903a6
    175  1.1  christos #define MTLR_0		0x7c0803a6
    176  1.1  christos #define NOP		0x60000000
    177  1.1  christos #define SUB_11_11_12	0x7d6c5850
    178  1.1  christos 
    179  1.1  christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
    180  1.1  christos #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
    181  1.1  christos #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
    182  1.1  christos 
    183  1.1  christos /* The value of a defined global symbol.  */
    184  1.1  christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
    185  1.1  christos   ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma	\
    186  1.1  christos    + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset		\
    187  1.1  christos    + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
    188  1.1  christos 
    189  1.8  christos /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
    191  1.8  christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
    192  1.8  christos    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
    193  1.8  christos    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
    194  1.8  christos    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
    195  1.8  christos    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
    196  1.8  christos    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
    197  1.8  christos    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
    198  1.8  christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
    199  1.8  christos 	    complain, special_func)				\
    200  1.8  christos   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
    201  1.8  christos 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
    202  1.8  christos 	 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
    203  1.1  christos 
    204  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
    205  1.1  christos 
    206  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
    207  1.8  christos   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
    208  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    209  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    210  1.1  christos 
    211  1.8  christos   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
    212  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    213  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    214  1.1  christos 
    215  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    216  1.8  christos      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    217  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    218  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    219  1.1  christos 
    220  1.8  christos   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
    221  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
    222  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    223  1.1  christos 
    224  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
    225  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    226  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    227  1.1  christos 
    228  1.8  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of an address.  */
    229  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    230  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    231  1.1  christos 
    232  1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
    233  1.8  christos      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    234  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    235  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    236  1.1  christos 
    237  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    238  1.8  christos      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    239  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    240  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    241  1.1  christos 
    242  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    243  1.1  christos      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.	The lower two
    244  1.8  christos      bits must be zero.  */
    245  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    246  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    247  1.1  christos 
    248  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    249  1.1  christos      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
    250  1.8  christos      two bits must be zero.  */
    251  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    252  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    253  1.1  christos 
    254  1.8  christos   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    255  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    256  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    257  1.1  christos 
    258  1.8  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    259  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    260  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    261  1.1  christos 
    262  1.1  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    263  1.1  christos      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
    264  1.8  christos      zero.  */
    265  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    266  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    267  1.1  christos 
    268  1.1  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    269  1.1  christos      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
    270  1.8  christos      be zero.  */
    271  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    272  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    273  1.1  christos 
    274  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
    275  1.8  christos      symbol.  */
    276  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    277  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    278  1.1  christos 
    279  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    280  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    281  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    282  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    283  1.1  christos 
    284  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    285  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    286  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    287  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    288  1.1  christos 
    289  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    290  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    291  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    292  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    293  1.1  christos 
    294  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
    295  1.8  christos      entry for the symbol.  */
    296  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    297  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    298  1.1  christos 
    299  1.1  christos   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
    300  1.1  christos      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
    301  1.1  christos      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
    302  1.1  christos      shared library into the object, because the object being
    303  1.8  christos      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
    304  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    305  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    306  1.1  christos 
    307  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
    308  1.8  christos      entries.  */
    309  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    310  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    311  1.1  christos 
    312  1.8  christos   /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol.  */
    313  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    314  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    315  1.1  christos 
    316  1.1  christos   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
    317  1.1  christos      longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
    318  1.8  christos      addend.  */
    319  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    320  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    321  1.1  christos 
    322  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
    323  1.1  christos      object rather than the final value.  Normally used for
    324  1.8  christos      _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
    325  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    326  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    327  1.1  christos 
    328  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
    329  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    330  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    331  1.1  christos 
    332  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
    333  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
    334  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    335  1.1  christos 
    336  1.8  christos   /* 32-bit PC relative */
    337  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
    338  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    339  1.1  christos 
    340  1.1  christos   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    341  1.8  christos      FIXME: not supported.  */
    342  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    343  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    344  1.1  christos 
    345  1.1  christos   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    346  1.8  christos      FIXME: not supported.  */
    347  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
    348  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    349  1.1  christos 
    350  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    351  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    352  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    353  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    354  1.1  christos 
    355  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    356  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    357  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    358  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    359  1.1  christos 
    360  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    361  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    362  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    363  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    364  1.1  christos 
    365  1.1  christos   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
    366  1.8  christos      small data items.  */
    367  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    368  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    369  1.1  christos 
    370  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
    371  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    372  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    373  1.1  christos 
    374  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation.  */
    375  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    376  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    377  1.1  christos 
    378  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
    379  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    380  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    381  1.1  christos 
    382  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
    383  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    384  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    385  1.1  christos 
    386  1.8  christos   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
    387  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    388  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    389  1.8  christos 
    390  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    391  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    392  1.8  christos 
    393  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    394  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    395  1.8  christos 
    396  1.8  christos   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
    397  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    398  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    399  1.8  christos 
    400  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    401  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    402  1.1  christos 
    403  1.1  christos   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
    404  1.8  christos      definition of its TLS sym.  */
    405  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    406  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    407  1.1  christos 
    408  1.1  christos   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
    409  1.1  christos      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
    410  1.8  christos      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
    411  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    412  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    413  1.1  christos 
    414  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
    415  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    416  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    417  1.1  christos 
    418  1.8  christos   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    419  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    420  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    421  1.1  christos 
    422  1.8  christos   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    423  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    424  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    425  1.1  christos 
    426  1.8  christos   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    427  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    428  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    429  1.1  christos 
    430  1.1  christos   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
    431  1.8  christos      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
    432  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    433  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    434  1.1  christos 
    435  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
    436  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    437  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    438  1.1  christos 
    439  1.8  christos   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    440  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    441  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    442  1.1  christos 
    443  1.8  christos   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    444  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    445  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    446  1.1  christos 
    447  1.8  christos   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    448  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    449  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    450  1.1  christos 
    451  1.1  christos   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    452  1.1  christos      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
    453  1.8  christos      to the first entry.  */
    454  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    455  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    456  1.1  christos 
    457  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
    458  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    459  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    460  1.1  christos 
    461  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    462  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    463  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    464  1.1  christos 
    465  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    466  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    467  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    468  1.1  christos 
    469  1.1  christos   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    470  1.1  christos      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
    471  1.8  christos      first entry.  */
    472  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    473  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    474  1.1  christos 
    475  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
    476  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    477  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    478  1.1  christos 
    479  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    480  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    481  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    482  1.1  christos 
    483  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    484  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    485  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    486  1.1  christos 
    487  1.1  christos   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
    488  1.8  christos      the offset to the entry.  */
    489  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    490  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    491  1.1  christos 
    492  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    493  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    494  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    495  1.1  christos 
    496  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    497  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    498  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    499  1.1  christos 
    500  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    501  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    502  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    503  1.1  christos 
    504  1.1  christos   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
    505  1.8  christos      offset to the entry.  */
    506  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    507  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    508  1.1  christos 
    509  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    510  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    511  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    512  1.1  christos 
    513  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    514  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    515  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    516  1.1  christos 
    517  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    518  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    519  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    520  1.1  christos 
    521  1.1  christos   /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
    522  1.1  christos      in the SVR4 ELF ABI.  */
    523  1.1  christos 
    524  1.8  christos   /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    525  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    526  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    527  1.1  christos 
    528  1.8  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    529  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    530  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    531  1.1  christos 
    532  1.8  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    533  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    534  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    535  1.1  christos 
    536  1.8  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol.  */
    537  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    538  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    539  1.1  christos 
    540  1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
    541  1.1  christos      plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
    542  1.8  christos      is negative.  */
    543  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    544  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    545  1.1  christos 
    546  1.1  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    547  1.1  christos      address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
    548  1.8  christos      _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    549  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    550  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    551  1.1  christos 
    552  1.1  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    553  1.1  christos      address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
    554  1.8  christos      _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    555  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    556  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    557  1.1  christos 
    558  1.1  christos   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
    559  1.8  christos      small data items.	 */
    560  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    561  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    562  1.1  christos 
    563  1.1  christos   /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
    564  1.1  christos      signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
    565  1.8  christos      field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    566  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    567  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    568  1.1  christos 
    569  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
    570  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
    571  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
    572  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
    573  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
    574  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
    575  1.1  christos 
    576  1.1  christos   /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
    577  1.1  christos      in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
    578  1.8  christos      register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    579  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    580  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    581  1.1  christos 
    582  1.8  christos   /* A relative 8 bit branch.  */
    583  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
    584  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    585  1.1  christos 
    586  1.8  christos   /* A relative 15 bit branch.  */
    587  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
    588  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    589  1.1  christos 
    590  1.8  christos   /* A relative 24 bit branch.  */
    591  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
    592  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    593  1.1  christos 
    594  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format.  */
    595  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    596  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    597  1.1  christos 
    598  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format.  */
    599  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    600  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    601  1.1  christos 
    602  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 split16a format.  */
    603  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    604  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    605  1.1  christos 
    606  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 split16d format.  */
    607  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    608  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    609  1.1  christos 
    610  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format.  */
    611  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    612  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    613  1.1  christos 
    614  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format.  */
    615  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    616  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    617  1.3  christos 
    618  1.3  christos   /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
    619  1.3  christos      instructions.  If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
    620  1.8  christos      the e_add16i to an e_li instruction.  */
    621  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    622  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    623  1.3  christos 
    624  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow.  */
    625  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    626  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    627  1.1  christos 
    628  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    629  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    630  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    631  1.1  christos 
    632  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    633  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    634  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    635  1.1  christos 
    636  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    637  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    638  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    639  1.1  christos 
    640  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    641  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    642  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    643  1.1  christos 
    644  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format.  */
    645  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    646  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    647  1.1  christos 
    648  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format.  */
    649  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    650  1.8  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    651  1.8  christos 
    652  1.8  christos   /* e_li split20 format.  */
    653  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    654  1.8  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    655  1.8  christos 
    656  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    657  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    658  1.1  christos 
    659  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
    660  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
    661  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    662  1.1  christos 
    663  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
    664  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
    665  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    666  1.1  christos 
    667  1.8  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
    668  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
    669  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    670  1.1  christos 
    671  1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
    672  1.8  christos      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    673  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
    674  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    675  1.6  christos 
    676  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
    677  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
    678  1.6  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    679  1.7  christos 
    680  1.8  christos   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
    681  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
    682  1.7  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    683  1.1  christos 
    684  1.8  christos   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
    685  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    686  1.1  christos        NULL),
    687  1.1  christos 
    688  1.8  christos   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
    689  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    690  1.1  christos        NULL),
    691  1.1  christos 
    692  1.8  christos   /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries.  */
    693  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    694  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    695  1.1  christos };
    696  1.1  christos 
    697  1.1  christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done.  */
    699  1.1  christos 
    700  1.1  christos static void
    701  1.1  christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
    702  1.1  christos {
    703  1.1  christos   unsigned int i, type;
    704  1.1  christos 
    705  1.1  christos   for (i = 0;
    706  1.1  christos        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    707  1.1  christos        i++)
    708  1.1  christos     {
    709  1.1  christos       type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
    710  1.1  christos       if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
    711  1.1  christos 		   / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
    712  1.1  christos 	abort ();
    713  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    714  1.1  christos     }
    715  1.1  christos }
    716  1.1  christos 
    717  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *
    718  1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    719  1.1  christos 			   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
    720  1.1  christos {
    721  1.1  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
    722  1.1  christos 
    723  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    724  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    725  1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    726  1.1  christos 
    727  1.1  christos   switch (code)
    728  1.1  christos     {
    729  1.1  christos     default:
    730  1.1  christos       return NULL;
    731  1.1  christos 
    732  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:		r = R_PPC_NONE;			break;
    733  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32:			r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    734  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:		r = R_PPC_ADDR24;		break;
    735  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
    736  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16:			r = R_PPC_ADDR16;		break;
    737  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
    738  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO;		break;
    739  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI;		break;
    740  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA;		break;
    741  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR14;		break;
    742  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    743  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    744  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:		r = R_PPC_REL24;		break;
    745  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:		r = R_PPC_REL14;		break;
    746  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    747  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    748  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
    749  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16;		break;
    750  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
    751  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;		break;
    752  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI;		break;
    753  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:	r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA;		break;
    754  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL24;		break;
    755  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:		r = R_PPC_COPY;			break;
    756  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:	r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT;		break;
    757  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC:	r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC;		break;
    758  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL32;		break;
    759  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT32;		break;
    760  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL32;		break;
    761  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
    762  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO;		break;
    763  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI;		break;
    764  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:	r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA;		break;
    765  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16:		r = R_PPC_SDAREL16;		break;
    766  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
    767  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC_SECTOFF;		break;
    768  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
    769  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO;		break;
    770  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI;		break;
    771  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA;		break;
    772  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:		r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    773  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
    774  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:		r = R_PPC_TOC16;		break;
    775  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:		r = R_PPC_TLS;			break;
    776  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:		r = R_PPC_TLSGD;		break;
    777  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:		r = R_PPC_TLSLD;		break;
    778  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:		r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32;		break;
    779  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
    780  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC_TPREL16;		break;
    781  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
    782  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;		break;
    783  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI;		break;
    784  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;		break;
    785  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:		r = R_PPC_TPREL32;		break;
    786  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
    787  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16;		break;
    788  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
    789  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO;		break;
    790  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI;		break;
    791  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA;		break;
    792  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:		r = R_PPC_DTPREL32;		break;
    793  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16;		break;
    794  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;	break;
    795  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;	break;
    796  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;	break;
    797  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16;		break;
    798  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;	break;
    799  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;	break;
    800  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;	break;
    801  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16;		break;
    802  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO;	break;
    803  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI;	break;
    804  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA;	break;
    805  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16;		break;
    806  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO;	break;
    807  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;	break;
    808  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;	break;
    809  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32;		break;
    810  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16;		break;
    811  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO;	break;
    812  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI;	break;
    813  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA;	break;
    814  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16;		break;
    815  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16;		break;
    816  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL;		break;
    817  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21;		break;
    818  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:	r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF;		break;
    819  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16;		break;
    820  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO;		break;
    821  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI;		break;
    822  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA;		break;
    823  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:	r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD;		break;
    824  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA;		break;
    825  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8;		break;
    826  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15;		break;
    827  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24;		break;
    828  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A;		break;
    829  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D;		break;
    830  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A;		break;
    831  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D;		break;
    832  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A;		break;
    833  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D;		break;
    834  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21;		break;
    835  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO;		break;
    836  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
    837  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
    838  1.1  christos       break;
    839  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
    840  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
    841  1.1  christos       break;
    842  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
    843  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
    844  1.1  christos       break;
    845  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
    846  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
    847  1.1  christos       break;
    848  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
    849  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
    850  1.1  christos       break;
    851  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
    852  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
    853  1.1  christos       break;
    854  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16;		break;
    855  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_LO;		break;
    856  1.7  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_HI;		break;
    857  1.6  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_REL16_HA;		break;
    858  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC_16DX_HA;		break;
    859  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:	r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA;		break;
    860  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT;	break;
    861  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY;		break;
    862  1.1  christos     }
    863  1.1  christos 
    864  1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
    865  1.1  christos };
    866  1.1  christos 
    867  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *
    868  1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    869  1.1  christos 			   const char *r_name)
    870  1.1  christos {
    871  1.1  christos   unsigned int i;
    872  1.1  christos 
    873  1.1  christos   for (i = 0;
    874  1.1  christos        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    875  1.1  christos        i++)
    876  1.1  christos     if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
    877  1.1  christos 	&& strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
    878  1.1  christos       return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    879  1.1  christos 
    880  1.1  christos   return NULL;
    881  1.1  christos }
    882  1.1  christos 
    883  1.8  christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
    884  1.7  christos 
    885  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
    886  1.1  christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
    887  1.1  christos 		       arelent *cache_ptr,
    888  1.5  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
    889  1.5  christos {
    890  1.1  christos   unsigned int r_type;
    891  1.1  christos 
    892  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    893  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    894  1.5  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    895  1.5  christos 
    896  1.5  christos   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
    897  1.7  christos   if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
    898  1.8  christos     {
    899  1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    900  1.5  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    901  1.8  christos 			  abfd, r_type);
    902  1.5  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    903  1.8  christos       return FALSE;
    904  1.5  christos     }
    905  1.1  christos 
    906  1.1  christos   cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
    907  1.1  christos 
    908  1.8  christos   /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
    909  1.1  christos      ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation.  */
    910  1.7  christos   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
    911  1.8  christos     {
    912  1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    913  1.1  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    914  1.1  christos 			  abfd, r_type);
    915  1.8  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    916  1.1  christos 
    917  1.8  christos       return FALSE;
    918  1.8  christos     }
    919  1.1  christos 
    920  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
    921  1.1  christos }
    922  1.1  christos 
    923  1.1  christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs.  */
    924  1.7  christos 
    925  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
    926  1.1  christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    927  1.7  christos 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    928  1.1  christos 			 asymbol *symbol,
    929  1.1  christos 			 void *data,
    930  1.1  christos 			 asection *input_section,
    931  1.1  christos 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    932  1.6  christos 			 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
    933  1.6  christos {
    934  1.6  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
    935  1.6  christos   long insn;
    936  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type octets;
    937  1.1  christos   bfd_vma value;
    938  1.1  christos 
    939  1.1  christos   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    940  1.1  christos     {
    941  1.1  christos       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
    942  1.1  christos       return bfd_reloc_ok;
    943  1.6  christos     }
    944  1.6  christos 
    945  1.6  christos   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
    946  1.6  christos   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
    947  1.6  christos   if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
    948  1.6  christos     return bfd_reloc_continue;
    949  1.6  christos 
    950  1.6  christos   value = 0;
    951  1.6  christos   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
    952  1.6  christos     value = symbol->value;
    953  1.6  christos   value += (reloc_entry->addend
    954  1.6  christos 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
    955  1.6  christos 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
    956  1.6  christos   value -= (reloc_entry->address
    957  1.6  christos 	    + input_section->output_offset
    958  1.6  christos 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
    959  1.6  christos   value >>= 16;
    960  1.6  christos 
    961  1.6  christos   octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
    962  1.6  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    963  1.6  christos   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
    964  1.6  christos   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
    965  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    966  1.1  christos   return bfd_reloc_ok;
    967  1.1  christos }
    968  1.1  christos 
    969  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
    970  1.1  christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    971  1.1  christos 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    972  1.1  christos 			 asymbol *symbol,
    973  1.1  christos 			 void *data,
    974  1.1  christos 			 asection *input_section,
    975  1.1  christos 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    976  1.1  christos 			 char **error_message)
    977  1.1  christos {
    978  1.1  christos   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
    979  1.1  christos      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
    980  1.1  christos      link time.  */
    981  1.1  christos   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    982  1.1  christos     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
    983  1.1  christos 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
    984  1.1  christos 
    985  1.1  christos   if (error_message != NULL)
    986  1.1  christos     {
    987  1.1  christos       static char buf[60];
    988  1.1  christos       sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
    989  1.1  christos 	       reloc_entry->howto->name);
    990  1.1  christos       *error_message = buf;
    991  1.1  christos     }
    992  1.1  christos   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
    993  1.1  christos }
    994  1.1  christos 
    995  1.1  christos /* Sections created by the linker.  */
    997  1.1  christos 
    998  1.1  christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
    999  1.1  christos {
   1000  1.1  christos   /* Pointer to the bfd section.  */
   1001  1.1  christos   asection *section;
   1002  1.1  christos   /* Section name.  */
   1003  1.1  christos   const char *name;
   1004  1.1  christos   /* Associated bss section name.  */
   1005  1.1  christos   const char *bss_name;
   1006  1.1  christos   /* Associated symbol name.  */
   1007  1.1  christos   const char *sym_name;
   1008  1.1  christos   /* Associated symbol.  */
   1009  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
   1010  1.1  christos } elf_linker_section_t;
   1011  1.1  christos 
   1012  1.1  christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries.  This hangs off of the
   1013  1.1  christos    symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
   1014  1.1  christos    based on different addend's.  */
   1015  1.1  christos 
   1016  1.1  christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
   1017  1.1  christos {
   1018  1.1  christos   /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
   1019  1.1  christos   struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
   1020  1.1  christos   /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
   1021  1.1  christos   bfd_vma offset;
   1022  1.1  christos   /* addend used */
   1023  1.1  christos   bfd_vma addend;
   1024  1.1  christos   /* which linker section this is */
   1025  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
   1026  1.1  christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
   1027  1.1  christos 
   1028  1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
   1029  1.1  christos {
   1030  1.1  christos   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
   1031  1.1  christos 
   1032  1.1  christos   /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
   1033  1.1  christos      sections added.  This is index by the symbol index.  */
   1034  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
   1035  1.1  christos 
   1036  1.1  christos   /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type.  */
   1037  1.1  christos   unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
   1038  1.1  christos   unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
   1039  1.1  christos };
   1040  1.1  christos 
   1041  1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
   1042  1.1  christos   ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
   1043  1.1  christos 
   1044  1.1  christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
   1045  1.1  christos   (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
   1046  1.1  christos 
   1047  1.1  christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
   1048  1.1  christos   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
   1049  1.1  christos    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
   1050  1.1  christos 
   1051  1.1  christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
   1052  1.1  christos 
   1053  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1054  1.1  christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
   1055  1.1  christos {
   1056  1.1  christos   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
   1057  1.6  christos 				  PPC32_ELF_DATA);
   1058  1.6  christos }
   1059  1.6  christos 
   1060  1.6  christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match.  */
   1061  1.6  christos 
   1062  1.6  christos bfd_boolean
   1063  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
   1064  1.6  christos {
   1065  1.6  christos   unsigned long mach = 0;
   1066  1.6  christos   asection *s;
   1067  1.6  christos   unsigned char *contents;
   1068  1.6  christos 
   1069  1.6  christos   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
   1070  1.6  christos       && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
   1071  1.6  christos     {
   1072  1.6  christos 
   1073  1.6  christos       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   1074  1.6  christos 	if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1075  1.6  christos 	  break;
   1076  1.6  christos       if (s != NULL)
   1077  1.6  christos 	mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1078  1.6  christos     }
   1079  1.6  christos 
   1080  1.6  christos   if (mach == 0)
   1081  1.6  christos     {
   1082  1.6  christos       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1083  1.6  christos       if (s != NULL && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
   1084  1.6  christos 	{
   1085  1.6  christos 	  unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
   1086  1.6  christos 	  unsigned int i;
   1087  1.6  christos 
   1088  1.6  christos 	  for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
   1089  1.6  christos 	    {
   1090  1.6  christos 	      unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
   1091  1.6  christos 	      switch (val >> 16)
   1092  1.6  christos 		{
   1093  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
   1094  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
   1095  1.6  christos 		  if (mach == 0)
   1096  1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
   1097  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1098  1.6  christos 
   1099  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
   1100  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
   1101  1.6  christos 		  if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
   1102  1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
   1103  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1104  1.6  christos 
   1105  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
   1106  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
   1107  1.7  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
   1108  1.6  christos 		  if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
   1109  1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
   1110  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1111  1.6  christos 
   1112  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
   1113  1.6  christos 		  mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1114  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1115  1.6  christos 
   1116  1.6  christos 		default:
   1117  1.6  christos 		  mach = -1ul;
   1118  1.6  christos 		}
   1119  1.6  christos 	    }
   1120  1.6  christos 	  free (contents);
   1121  1.6  christos 	}
   1122  1.6  christos     }
   1123  1.6  christos 
   1124  1.6  christos   if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
   1125  1.6  christos     {
   1126  1.6  christos       const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
   1127  1.6  christos 
   1128  1.6  christos       for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
   1129  1.6  christos 	if (arch->mach == mach)
   1130  1.6  christos 	  {
   1131  1.6  christos 	    abfd->arch_info = arch;
   1132  1.6  christos 	    break;
   1133  1.6  christos 	  }
   1134  1.6  christos     }
   1135  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1136  1.6  christos }
   1137  1.1  christos 
   1138  1.1  christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
   1139  1.1  christos    default is 64 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
   1140  1.1  christos 
   1141  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   1142  1.6  christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
   1143  1.6  christos {
   1144  1.6  christos   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
   1145  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   1146  1.1  christos 
   1147  1.1  christos   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
   1148  1.1  christos     {
   1149  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   1150  1.1  christos 
   1151  1.1  christos       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
   1152  1.1  christos 	{
   1153  1.1  christos 	  /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default.  */
   1154  1.1  christos 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
   1155  1.6  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
   1156  1.1  christos 	}
   1157  1.1  christos     }
   1158  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
   1159  1.1  christos }
   1160  1.1  christos 
   1161  1.1  christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set.  */
   1162  1.1  christos 
   1163  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1164  1.1  christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
   1165  1.1  christos {
   1166  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
   1167  1.1  christos 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
   1168  1.1  christos 
   1169  1.1  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
   1170  1.1  christos   elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
   1171  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1172  1.1  christos }
   1173  1.1  christos 
   1174  1.1  christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
   1175  1.1  christos 
   1176  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1177  1.1  christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1178  1.1  christos {
   1179  1.1  christos   int offset;
   1180  1.1  christos   unsigned int size;
   1181  1.1  christos 
   1182  1.1  christos   switch (note->descsz)
   1183  1.1  christos     {
   1184  1.1  christos     default:
   1185  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   1186  1.1  christos 
   1187  1.1  christos     case 268:		/* Linux/PPC.  */
   1188  1.1  christos       /* pr_cursig */
   1189  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   1190  1.1  christos 
   1191  1.1  christos       /* pr_pid */
   1192  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
   1193  1.1  christos 
   1194  1.1  christos       /* pr_reg */
   1195  1.1  christos       offset = 72;
   1196  1.1  christos       size = 192;
   1197  1.1  christos 
   1198  1.1  christos       break;
   1199  1.1  christos     }
   1200  1.1  christos 
   1201  1.1  christos   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   1202  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   1203  1.1  christos 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   1204  1.1  christos }
   1205  1.1  christos 
   1206  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1207  1.1  christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1208  1.1  christos {
   1209  1.1  christos   switch (note->descsz)
   1210  1.1  christos     {
   1211  1.1  christos     default:
   1212  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   1213  1.1  christos 
   1214  1.1  christos     case 128:		/* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo.  */
   1215  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   1216  1.1  christos 	= bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
   1217  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   1218  1.1  christos 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
   1219  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   1220  1.1  christos 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
   1221  1.1  christos     }
   1222  1.1  christos 
   1223  1.1  christos   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   1224  1.1  christos      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   1225  1.1  christos      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   1226  1.1  christos 
   1227  1.1  christos   {
   1228  1.1  christos     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
   1229  1.1  christos     int n = strlen (command);
   1230  1.1  christos 
   1231  1.1  christos     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   1232  1.1  christos       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   1233  1.1  christos   }
   1234  1.1  christos 
   1235  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1236  1.1  christos }
   1237  1.1  christos 
   1238  1.1  christos static char *
   1239  1.1  christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
   1240  1.1  christos {
   1241  1.1  christos   switch (note_type)
   1242  1.1  christos     {
   1243  1.1  christos     default:
   1244  1.1  christos       return NULL;
   1245  1.8  christos 
   1246  1.1  christos     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   1247  1.1  christos       {
   1248  1.1  christos 	char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
   1249  1.1  christos 	va_list ap;
   1250  1.1  christos 
   1251  1.8  christos 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1252  1.8  christos 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
   1253  1.8  christos 	strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
   1254  1.8  christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1255  1.8  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
   1256  1.8  christos 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
   1257  1.8  christos 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
   1258  1.8  christos 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
   1259  1.1  christos 	 */
   1260  1.8  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
   1261  1.8  christos #endif
   1262  1.8  christos 	strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
   1263  1.1  christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1264  1.1  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
   1265  1.1  christos #endif
   1266  1.1  christos 	va_end (ap);
   1267  1.1  christos 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1268  1.1  christos 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1269  1.1  christos       }
   1270  1.1  christos 
   1271  1.1  christos     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   1272  1.1  christos       {
   1273  1.1  christos 	char data[268];
   1274  1.1  christos 	va_list ap;
   1275  1.1  christos 	long pid;
   1276  1.1  christos 	int cursig;
   1277  1.1  christos 	const void *greg;
   1278  1.1  christos 
   1279  1.1  christos 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1280  1.1  christos 	memset (data, 0, 72);
   1281  1.1  christos 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
   1282  1.1  christos 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
   1283  1.1  christos 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
   1284  1.1  christos 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
   1285  1.1  christos 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
   1286  1.1  christos 	memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
   1287  1.1  christos 	memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
   1288  1.1  christos 	va_end (ap);
   1289  1.1  christos 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1290  1.1  christos 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1291  1.1  christos       }
   1292  1.1  christos     }
   1293  1.1  christos }
   1294  1.1  christos 
   1295  1.1  christos static flagword
   1296  1.1  christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
   1297  1.1  christos {
   1298  1.1  christos 
   1299  1.1  christos   if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
   1300  1.1  christos     return SHF_PPC_VLE;
   1301  1.1  christos 
   1302  1.1  christos   return 0;
   1303  1.1  christos }
   1304  1.1  christos 
   1305  1.1  christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
   1306  1.1  christos    or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included.  */
   1307  1.1  christos 
   1308  1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   1309  1.1  christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1310  1.1  christos 		     const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1311  1.1  christos 		     const arelent *rel)
   1312  1.1  christos {
   1313  1.1  christos   return rel->address;
   1314  1.1  christos }
   1315  1.1  christos 
   1316  1.1  christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file.  This
   1317  1.1  christos    is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
   1318  1.1  christos    type.  */
   1319  1.1  christos 
   1320  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1321  1.1  christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   1322  1.1  christos 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
   1323  1.1  christos 			   const char *name,
   1324  1.1  christos 			   int shindex)
   1325  1.1  christos {
   1326  1.1  christos   asection *newsect;
   1327  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   1328  1.1  christos 
   1329  1.1  christos   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1330  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   1331  1.1  christos 
   1332  1.1  christos   newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
   1333  1.1  christos   flags = bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, newsect);
   1334  1.1  christos   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
   1335  1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   1336  1.1  christos 
   1337  1.1  christos   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
   1338  1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
   1339  1.1  christos 
   1340  1.1  christos   bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags);
   1341  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1342  1.1  christos }
   1343  1.1  christos 
   1344  1.1  christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary.  */
   1345  1.1  christos 
   1346  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1347  1.1  christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1348  1.1  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
   1349  1.1  christos 		       asection *asect)
   1350  1.1  christos {
   1351  1.1  christos   if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
   1352  1.1  christos     shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
   1353  1.1  christos 
   1354  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1355  1.1  christos }
   1356  1.1  christos 
   1357  1.1  christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
   1358  1.1  christos    need to bump up the number of section headers.  */
   1359  1.1  christos 
   1360  1.1  christos static int
   1361  1.1  christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
   1362  1.1  christos 				    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1363  1.1  christos {
   1364  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   1365  1.1  christos   int ret = 0;
   1366  1.1  christos 
   1367  1.1  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
   1368  1.1  christos   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1369  1.1  christos     ++ret;
   1370  1.1  christos 
   1371  1.1  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
   1372  1.1  christos   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1373  1.1  christos     ++ret;
   1374  1.1  christos 
   1375  1.1  christos   return ret;
   1376  1.1  christos }
   1377  1.1  christos 
   1378  1.1  christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables.  */
   1379  1.1  christos 
   1380  1.1  christos bfd_boolean
   1381  1.7  christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   1382  1.1  christos 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1383  1.1  christos {
   1384  1.1  christos   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   1385  1.1  christos 
   1386  1.1  christos   /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
   1387  1.1  christos      LMA and assigned to segments.  All that is left to do is to ensure
   1388  1.1  christos      there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
   1389  1.1  christos      If we find that case, we split the segment.
   1390  1.1  christos      We maintain the original output section order.  */
   1391  1.7  christos 
   1392  1.7  christos   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   1393  1.7  christos     {
   1394  1.7  christos       struct elf_segment_map *n;
   1395  1.7  christos       bfd_size_type amt;
   1396  1.7  christos       unsigned int j, k;
   1397  1.1  christos       unsigned int p_flags;
   1398  1.1  christos 
   1399  1.7  christos       if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
   1400  1.1  christos 	continue;
   1401  1.7  christos 
   1402  1.7  christos       for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
   1403  1.7  christos 	{
   1404  1.7  christos 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1405  1.7  christos 	    p_flags |= PF_W;
   1406  1.7  christos 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1407  1.7  christos 	    {
   1408  1.7  christos 	      p_flags |= PF_X;
   1409  1.7  christos 	      if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1410  1.7  christos 		p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1411  1.7  christos 	      break;
   1412  1.7  christos 	    }
   1413  1.7  christos 	}
   1414  1.7  christos       if (j != m->count)
   1415  1.1  christos 	while (++j != m->count)
   1416  1.7  christos 	  {
   1417  1.7  christos 	    unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
   1418  1.7  christos 
   1419  1.7  christos 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1420  1.7  christos 	      p_flags1 |= PF_W;
   1421  1.7  christos 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1422  1.7  christos 	      {
   1423  1.7  christos 		p_flags1 |= PF_X;
   1424  1.7  christos 		if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1425  1.7  christos 		  p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1426  1.7  christos 		if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1427  1.7  christos 		  break;
   1428  1.7  christos 	      }
   1429  1.7  christos 	    p_flags |= p_flags1;
   1430  1.7  christos 	  }
   1431  1.7  christos       /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
   1432  1.7  christos 	 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
   1433  1.7  christos 	 two parts.  So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
   1434  1.7  christos 	 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set.  */
   1435  1.7  christos       if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
   1436  1.7  christos 	{
   1437  1.7  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   1438  1.1  christos 	  m->p_flags = p_flags;
   1439  1.1  christos 	}
   1440  1.7  christos       if (j == m->count)
   1441  1.1  christos 	continue;
   1442  1.1  christos 
   1443  1.1  christos       /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
   1444  1.1  christos 	 the remainder are put in a new segment.
   1445  1.1  christos 	 The scan resumes with the new segment.  */
   1446  1.1  christos 
   1447  1.1  christos       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   1448  1.8  christos       amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   1449  1.1  christos       n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   1450  1.1  christos       if (n == NULL)
   1451  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   1452  1.1  christos 
   1453  1.7  christos       n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   1454  1.7  christos       n->count = m->count - j;
   1455  1.7  christos       for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
   1456  1.1  christos 	n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
   1457  1.1  christos       m->count = j;
   1458  1.1  christos       m->p_size_valid = 0;
   1459  1.1  christos       n->next = m->next;
   1460  1.1  christos       m->next = n;
   1461  1.1  christos     }
   1462  1.1  christos 
   1463  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1464  1.1  christos }
   1465  1.1  christos 
   1466  1.1  christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
   1467  1.1  christos    .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
   1468  1.1  christos    that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
   1469  1.1  christos    2 sections.  */
   1470  1.6  christos 
   1471  1.6  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
   1472  1.6  christos {
   1473  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   1474  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1475  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1476  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1477  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1478  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
   1479  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
   1480  1.1  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1481  1.1  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1482  1.1  christos   { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
   1483  1.1  christos };
   1484  1.8  christos 
   1485  1.1  christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got.  */
   1486  1.1  christos static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
   1487  1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
   1488  1.1  christos 
   1489  1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   1490  1.1  christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   1491  1.1  christos {
   1492  1.1  christos   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   1493  1.1  christos 
   1494  1.1  christos   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   1495  1.1  christos   if (sec->name == NULL)
   1496  1.1  christos     return NULL;
   1497  1.1  christos 
   1498  1.1  christos   ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
   1499  1.1  christos 					sec->use_rela_p);
   1500  1.1  christos   if (ssect != NULL)
   1501  1.1  christos     {
   1502  1.1  christos       if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   1503  1.1  christos 	ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
   1504  1.1  christos       return ssect;
   1505  1.1  christos     }
   1506  1.1  christos 
   1507  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   1508  1.1  christos }
   1509  1.1  christos 
   1510  1.1  christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values.  */
   1512  1.1  christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
   1513  1.1  christos {
   1514  1.1  christos   struct apuinfo_list *next;
   1515  1.1  christos   unsigned long value;
   1516  1.1  christos }
   1517  1.1  christos apuinfo_list;
   1518  1.1  christos 
   1519  1.1  christos static apuinfo_list *head;
   1520  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
   1521  1.1  christos 
   1522  1.1  christos static void
   1523  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
   1524  1.1  christos {
   1525  1.1  christos   head = NULL;
   1526  1.1  christos   apuinfo_set = FALSE;
   1527  1.1  christos }
   1528  1.1  christos 
   1529  1.1  christos static void
   1530  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
   1531  1.1  christos {
   1532  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry = head;
   1533  1.1  christos 
   1534  1.1  christos   while (entry != NULL)
   1535  1.1  christos     {
   1536  1.1  christos       if (entry->value == value)
   1537  1.1  christos 	return;
   1538  1.1  christos       entry = entry->next;
   1539  1.1  christos     }
   1540  1.1  christos 
   1541  1.1  christos   entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
   1542  1.1  christos   if (entry == NULL)
   1543  1.1  christos     return;
   1544  1.1  christos 
   1545  1.1  christos   entry->value = value;
   1546  1.1  christos   entry->next  = head;
   1547  1.1  christos   head = entry;
   1548  1.1  christos }
   1549  1.1  christos 
   1550  1.1  christos static unsigned
   1551  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
   1552  1.1  christos {
   1553  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1554  1.1  christos   unsigned long count;
   1555  1.1  christos 
   1556  1.1  christos   for (entry = head, count = 0;
   1557  1.1  christos        entry;
   1558  1.1  christos        entry = entry->next)
   1559  1.1  christos     ++ count;
   1560  1.1  christos 
   1561  1.1  christos   return count;
   1562  1.1  christos }
   1563  1.1  christos 
   1564  1.1  christos static inline unsigned long
   1565  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
   1566  1.1  christos {
   1567  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list * entry;
   1568  1.1  christos 
   1569  1.1  christos   for (entry = head;
   1570  1.1  christos        entry && number --;
   1571  1.1  christos        entry = entry->next)
   1572  1.1  christos     ;
   1573  1.1  christos 
   1574  1.1  christos   return entry ? entry->value : 0;
   1575  1.1  christos }
   1576  1.1  christos 
   1577  1.1  christos static void
   1578  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
   1579  1.1  christos {
   1580  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1581  1.1  christos 
   1582  1.1  christos   for (entry = head; entry;)
   1583  1.1  christos     {
   1584  1.1  christos       apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
   1585  1.1  christos       free (entry);
   1586  1.1  christos       entry = next;
   1587  1.1  christos     }
   1588  1.1  christos 
   1589  1.1  christos   head = NULL;
   1590  1.1  christos }
   1591  1.1  christos 
   1592  1.1  christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
   1593  1.1  christos    the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted.  */
   1594  1.1  christos 
   1595  1.1  christos static void
   1596  1.1  christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   1597  1.1  christos {
   1598  1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   1599  1.1  christos   asection *asec;
   1600  1.1  christos   char *buffer = NULL;
   1601  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
   1602  1.1  christos   unsigned i;
   1603  1.1  christos   unsigned long length;
   1604  1.1  christos   const char *error_message = NULL;
   1605  1.1  christos 
   1606  1.1  christos   if (link_info == NULL)
   1607  1.1  christos     return;
   1608  1.3  christos 
   1609  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list_init ();
   1610  1.1  christos 
   1611  1.1  christos   /* Read in the input sections contents.  */
   1612  1.1  christos   for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   1613  1.1  christos     {
   1614  1.1  christos       unsigned long datum;
   1615  1.1  christos 
   1616  1.7  christos       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1617  1.8  christos       if (asec == NULL)
   1618  1.1  christos 	continue;
   1619  1.1  christos 
   1620  1.1  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
   1621  1.1  christos       error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
   1622  1.1  christos       length = asec->size;
   1623  1.1  christos       if (length < 20)
   1624  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1625  1.1  christos 
   1626  1.1  christos       apuinfo_set = TRUE;
   1627  1.1  christos       if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
   1628  1.1  christos 	{
   1629  1.1  christos 	  if (buffer)
   1630  1.1  christos 	    free (buffer);
   1631  1.1  christos 	  largest_input_size = asec->size;
   1632  1.1  christos 	  buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
   1633  1.1  christos 	  if (!buffer)
   1634  1.1  christos 	    return;
   1635  1.1  christos 	}
   1636  1.7  christos 
   1637  1.8  christos       if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   1638  1.1  christos 	  || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
   1639  1.1  christos 	{
   1640  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1641  1.1  christos 	  error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
   1642  1.1  christos 	  goto fail;
   1643  1.1  christos 	}
   1644  1.1  christos 
   1645  1.1  christos       /* Verify the contents of the header.  Note - we have to
   1646  1.1  christos 	 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
   1647  1.1  christos 	 host whose endian-ness is different from the target.  */
   1648  1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
   1649  1.1  christos       if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
   1650  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1651  1.1  christos 
   1652  1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
   1653  1.1  christos       if (datum != 0x2)
   1654  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1655  1.1  christos 
   1656  1.1  christos       if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
   1657  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1658  1.1  christos 
   1659  1.1  christos       /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries.  */
   1660  1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
   1661  1.1  christos       if (datum + 20 != length)
   1662  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1663  1.1  christos 
   1664  1.1  christos       /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers.  */
   1665  1.1  christos       for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
   1666  1.1  christos 	apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
   1667  1.1  christos     }
   1668  1.1  christos 
   1669  1.1  christos   error_message = NULL;
   1670  1.1  christos 
   1671  1.1  christos   if (apuinfo_set)
   1672  1.1  christos     {
   1673  1.1  christos       /* Compute the size of the output section.  */
   1674  1.1  christos       unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1675  1.1  christos 
   1676  1.1  christos       /* Set the output section size, if it exists.  */
   1677  1.1  christos       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1678  1.7  christos 
   1679  1.8  christos       if (asec && ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
   1680  1.1  christos 	{
   1681  1.1  christos 	  ibfd = abfd;
   1682  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1683  1.1  christos 	  error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
   1684  1.1  christos 	}
   1685  1.1  christos     }
   1686  1.1  christos 
   1687  1.1  christos  fail:
   1688  1.8  christos   if (buffer)
   1689  1.1  christos     free (buffer);
   1690  1.1  christos 
   1691  1.1  christos   if (error_message)
   1692  1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
   1693  1.1  christos }
   1694  1.1  christos 
   1695  1.1  christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
   1696  1.1  christos    contents.  We have already stored this in our linked list structure.  */
   1697  1.1  christos 
   1698  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1699  1.1  christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1700  1.1  christos 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1701  1.1  christos 		       asection *asec,
   1702  1.1  christos 		       bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1703  1.1  christos {
   1704  1.1  christos   return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
   1705  1.1  christos }
   1706  1.1  christos 
   1707  1.1  christos /* Finally we can generate the output section.  */
   1708  1.1  christos 
   1709  1.1  christos static void
   1710  1.1  christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1711  1.1  christos {
   1712  1.1  christos   bfd_byte *buffer;
   1713  1.1  christos   asection *asec;
   1714  1.1  christos   unsigned i;
   1715  1.1  christos   unsigned num_entries;
   1716  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type length;
   1717  1.1  christos 
   1718  1.1  christos   asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1719  1.1  christos   if (asec == NULL)
   1720  1.1  christos     return;
   1721  1.1  christos 
   1722  1.1  christos   if (!apuinfo_set)
   1723  1.1  christos     return;
   1724  1.1  christos 
   1725  1.1  christos   length = asec->size;
   1726  1.1  christos   if (length < 20)
   1727  1.1  christos     return;
   1728  1.7  christos 
   1729  1.8  christos   buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
   1730  1.1  christos   if (buffer == NULL)
   1731  1.1  christos     {
   1732  1.1  christos       _bfd_error_handler
   1733  1.1  christos 	(_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
   1734  1.1  christos       return;
   1735  1.1  christos     }
   1736  1.1  christos 
   1737  1.1  christos   /* Create the apuinfo header.  */
   1738  1.1  christos   num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1739  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
   1740  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
   1741  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
   1742  1.1  christos   strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
   1743  1.1  christos 
   1744  1.1  christos   length = 20;
   1745  1.1  christos   for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
   1746  1.1  christos     {
   1747  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
   1748  1.8  christos       length += 4;
   1749  1.1  christos     }
   1750  1.1  christos 
   1751  1.8  christos   if (length != asec->size)
   1752  1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
   1753  1.1  christos 
   1754  1.1  christos   if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
   1755  1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
   1756  1.1  christos 
   1757  1.1  christos   free (buffer);
   1758  1.1  christos 
   1759  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list_finish ();
   1760  1.1  christos }
   1761  1.8  christos 
   1762  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1764  1.1  christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
   1765  1.1  christos {
   1766  1.1  christos   bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
   1767  1.1  christos 
   1768  1.1  christos   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
   1769  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   1770  1.1  christos 
   1771  1.1  christos   return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
   1772  1.1  christos 	  && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
   1773  1.1  christos 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
   1774  1.1  christos 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
   1775  1.1  christos }
   1776  1.1  christos 
   1777  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1778  1.1  christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
   1779  1.1  christos {
   1780  1.1  christos   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
   1781  1.1  christos   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   1782  1.1  christos 	  && section->vma <= vma
   1783  1.1  christos 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
   1784  1.1  christos }
   1785  1.1  christos 
   1786  1.1  christos static long
   1787  1.1  christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
   1788  1.1  christos 			      long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
   1789  1.1  christos 			      asymbol **ret)
   1790  1.8  christos {
   1791  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   1792  1.1  christos   asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
   1793  1.8  christos   bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
   1794  1.1  christos   bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
   1795  1.1  christos   bfd_vma stub_off;
   1796  1.1  christos   asymbol *s;
   1797  1.1  christos   arelent *p;
   1798  1.1  christos   long count, i, stub_delta;
   1799  1.1  christos   size_t size;
   1800  1.1  christos   char *names;
   1801  1.1  christos   bfd_byte buf[4];
   1802  1.1  christos 
   1803  1.1  christos   *ret = NULL;
   1804  1.1  christos 
   1805  1.1  christos   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   1806  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1807  1.1  christos 
   1808  1.1  christos   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   1809  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1810  1.1  christos 
   1811  1.1  christos   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
   1812  1.1  christos   if (relplt == NULL)
   1813  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1814  1.1  christos 
   1815  1.1  christos   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   1816  1.1  christos   if (plt == NULL)
   1817  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1818  1.1  christos 
   1819  1.1  christos   /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs.  */
   1820  1.1  christos   if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
   1821  1.1  christos     return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
   1822  1.1  christos 					  dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
   1823  1.1  christos 
   1824  1.1  christos   /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
   1825  1.1  christos      of .glink at got[1].  If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero.  */
   1826  1.1  christos   dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1827  1.1  christos   if (dynamic != NULL)
   1828  1.1  christos     {
   1829  1.1  christos       bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1830  1.1  christos       size_t extdynsize;
   1831  1.1  christos       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1832  1.1  christos 
   1833  1.1  christos       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
   1834  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   1835  1.1  christos 
   1836  1.1  christos       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1837  1.1  christos       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1838  1.1  christos 
   1839  1.1  christos       extdyn = dynbuf;
   1840  1.1  christos       extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
   1841  1.1  christos       for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
   1842  1.1  christos 	{
   1843  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1844  1.1  christos 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1845  1.1  christos 
   1846  1.1  christos 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1847  1.1  christos 	    break;
   1848  1.1  christos 
   1849  1.1  christos 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
   1850  1.1  christos 	    {
   1851  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1852  1.1  christos 	      asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
   1853  1.1  christos 	      if (got != NULL
   1854  1.1  christos 		  && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
   1855  1.1  christos 					       g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
   1856  1.1  christos 		glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1857  1.1  christos 	      break;
   1858  1.1  christos 	    }
   1859  1.1  christos 	}
   1860  1.1  christos       free (dynbuf);
   1861  1.1  christos     }
   1862  1.1  christos 
   1863  1.1  christos   /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry.  */
   1864  1.1  christos   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1865  1.1  christos     {
   1866  1.1  christos       if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
   1867  1.1  christos 	glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1868  1.1  christos     }
   1869  1.1  christos 
   1870  1.1  christos   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1871  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1872  1.1  christos 
   1873  1.1  christos   /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
   1874  1.1  christos      link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
   1875  1.1  christos      glink stubs now reside.  */
   1876  1.1  christos   glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
   1877  1.1  christos   if (glink == NULL)
   1878  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1879  1.1  christos 
   1880  1.1  christos   /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
   1881  1.1  christos      from the first glink stub.  */
   1882  1.1  christos   if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1883  1.1  christos 				glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
   1884  1.1  christos     {
   1885  1.1  christos       unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1886  1.1  christos 
   1887  1.1  christos       /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ...  */
   1888  1.1  christos       insn ^= B;
   1889  1.1  christos       if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
   1890  1.1  christos 	resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
   1891  1.1  christos 
   1892  1.1  christos       /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs.  */
   1893  1.1  christos       else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
   1894  1.1  christos 	for (i = 4;
   1895  1.1  christos 	     bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1896  1.1  christos 				       glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
   1897  1.1  christos 	     i += 4)
   1898  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
   1899  1.1  christos 	    {
   1900  1.1  christos 	      resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
   1901  1.1  christos 	      break;
   1902  1.1  christos 	    }
   1903  1.1  christos     }
   1904  1.8  christos 
   1905  1.8  christos   count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   1906  1.8  christos   /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
   1907  1.8  christos      multiple stubs for each plt entry.  If that is the case then
   1908  1.8  christos      there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
   1909  1.8  christos      of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
   1910  1.8  christos      The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
   1911  1.8  christos      GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   1912  1.1  christos   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1913  1.1  christos   for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
   1914  1.1  christos     if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
   1915  1.1  christos       break;
   1916  1.1  christos   if (stub_delta > 32)
   1917  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1918  1.1  christos 
   1919  1.1  christos   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   1920  1.1  christos   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
   1921  1.1  christos     return -1;
   1922  1.1  christos 
   1923  1.1  christos   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   1924  1.1  christos   p = relplt->relocation;
   1925  1.1  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
   1926  1.1  christos     {
   1927  1.1  christos       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   1928  1.1  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   1929  1.1  christos 	size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   1930  1.1  christos     }
   1931  1.1  christos 
   1932  1.1  christos   size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
   1933  1.1  christos 
   1934  1.1  christos   if (resolv_vma)
   1935  1.1  christos     size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   1936  1.8  christos 
   1937  1.1  christos   s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
   1938  1.5  christos   if (s == NULL)
   1939  1.5  christos     return -1;
   1940  1.1  christos 
   1941  1.1  christos   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1942  1.1  christos   names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
   1943  1.8  christos   p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
   1944  1.8  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   1945  1.8  christos     {
   1946  1.1  christos       size_t len;
   1947  1.1  christos 
   1948  1.1  christos       stub_off -= stub_delta;
   1949  1.1  christos       if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
   1950  1.1  christos 	stub_off -= 32;
   1951  1.1  christos       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   1952  1.1  christos       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   1953  1.8  christos 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   1954  1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   1955  1.1  christos 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   1956  1.1  christos       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1957  1.1  christos       s->section = glink;
   1958  1.1  christos       s->value = stub_off;
   1959  1.1  christos       s->name = names;
   1960  1.1  christos       s->udata.p = NULL;
   1961  1.1  christos       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   1962  1.1  christos       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   1963  1.1  christos       names += len;
   1964  1.1  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   1965  1.1  christos 	{
   1966  1.1  christos 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   1967  1.1  christos 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   1968  1.1  christos 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
   1969  1.5  christos 	  names += strlen (names);
   1970  1.1  christos 	}
   1971  1.1  christos       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   1972  1.1  christos       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   1973  1.1  christos       ++s;
   1974  1.1  christos       --p;
   1975  1.1  christos     }
   1976  1.1  christos 
   1977  1.1  christos   /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table.  */
   1978  1.1  christos   memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   1979  1.1  christos   s->the_bfd = abfd;
   1980  1.1  christos   s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1981  1.1  christos   s->section = glink;
   1982  1.1  christos   s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1983  1.1  christos   s->name = names;
   1984  1.1  christos   memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
   1985  1.1  christos   names += sizeof ("__glink");
   1986  1.1  christos   s++;
   1987  1.1  christos   count++;
   1988  1.1  christos 
   1989  1.1  christos   if (resolv_vma)
   1990  1.1  christos     {
   1991  1.1  christos       /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver.  */
   1992  1.1  christos       memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   1993  1.1  christos       s->the_bfd = abfd;
   1994  1.1  christos       s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1995  1.1  christos       s->section = glink;
   1996  1.1  christos       s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
   1997  1.1  christos       s->name = names;
   1998  1.1  christos       memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
   1999  1.1  christos       names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   2000  1.1  christos       s++;
   2001  1.1  christos       count++;
   2002  1.1  christos     }
   2003  1.1  christos 
   2004  1.1  christos   return count;
   2005  1.1  christos }
   2006  1.1  christos 
   2007  1.1  christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
   2009  1.1  christos    functions above are used generally.  They appear in this file more
   2010  1.1  christos    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
   2011  1.1  christos    ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
   2012  1.1  christos    ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
   2013  1.1  christos    called.  */
   2014  1.1  christos 
   2015  1.1  christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
   2016  1.1  christos    than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary.  */
   2017  1.1  christos struct plt_entry
   2018  1.1  christos {
   2019  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *next;
   2020  1.1  christos 
   2021  1.1  christos   /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
   2022  1.1  christos      This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
   2023  1.1  christos      GOT pointer reg.  It will always be at least 32768.  (Current
   2024  1.1  christos      gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
   2025  1.1  christos      sections together resulting in larger offsets).  */
   2026  1.1  christos   bfd_vma addend;
   2027  1.1  christos 
   2028  1.1  christos   /* The .got2 section.  */
   2029  1.1  christos   asection *sec;
   2030  1.1  christos 
   2031  1.1  christos   /* PLT refcount or offset.  */
   2032  1.1  christos   union
   2033  1.1  christos     {
   2034  1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2035  1.1  christos       bfd_vma offset;
   2036  1.8  christos     } plt;
   2037  1.8  christos 
   2038  1.8  christos   /* .glink stub offset.  */
   2039  1.1  christos   bfd_vma glink_offset;
   2040  1.1  christos };
   2041  1.1  christos 
   2042  1.1  christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
   2043  1.1  christos    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
   2044  1.1  christos    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
   2045  1.1  christos 
   2046  1.1  christos static int
   2047  1.8  christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2048  1.8  christos 		   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2049  1.8  christos {
   2050  1.8  christos   switch (r_type)
   2051  1.1  christos     {
   2052  1.1  christos     default:
   2053  1.1  christos       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
   2054  1.1  christos 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL32 is excluded because the
   2055  1.1  christos 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
   2056  1.1  christos 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set.  */
   2057  1.1  christos       return 1;
   2058  1.1  christos 
   2059  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL24:
   2060  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14:
   2061  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   2062  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   2063  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL32:
   2064  1.1  christos       return 0;
   2065  1.8  christos 
   2066  1.8  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   2067  1.8  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   2068  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   2069  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   2070  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   2071  1.1  christos       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
   2072  1.1  christos 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
   2073  1.1  christos       return bfd_link_dll (info);
   2074  1.1  christos     }
   2075  1.1  christos }
   2076  1.1  christos 
   2077  1.1  christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
   2078  1.1  christos    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
   2079  1.1  christos    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
   2080  1.1  christos    shared lib.  */
   2081  1.1  christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
   2082  1.1  christos 
   2083  1.1  christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
   2084  1.1  christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
   2085  1.1  christos {
   2086  1.1  christos   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
   2087  1.1  christos 
   2088  1.1  christos   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
   2089  1.1  christos   asection *sec;
   2090  1.1  christos 
   2091  1.1  christos   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
   2092  1.1  christos   unsigned int count : 31;
   2093  1.1  christos 
   2094  1.1  christos   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
   2095  1.1  christos   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
   2096  1.1  christos };
   2097  1.1  christos 
   2098  1.1  christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry.  */
   2099  1.1  christos 
   2100  1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
   2101  1.1  christos {
   2102  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
   2103  1.1  christos 
   2104  1.1  christos   /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
   2105  1.1  christos      specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
   2106  1.8  christos      from the beginning of the section.  */
   2107  1.8  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
   2108  1.8  christos 
   2109  1.8  christos   /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol.  */
   2110  1.8  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
   2111  1.8  christos 
   2112  1.8  christos   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
   2113  1.8  christos      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
   2114  1.8  christos      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
   2115  1.8  christos      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
   2116  1.8  christos      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
   2117  1.8  christos      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
   2118  1.8  christos      set TLS_TPRELGD when a GD reloc turns into a TPREL one.  We use a
   2119  1.8  christos      separate flag rather than setting TPREL just for convenience in
   2120  1.8  christos      distinguishing the two cases.
   2121  1.8  christos      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
   2122  1.8  christos #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
   2123  1.8  christos #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
   2124  1.8  christos #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
   2125  1.8  christos #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
   2126  1.8  christos #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
   2127  1.8  christos #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
   2128  1.8  christos #define TLS_TPRELGD	64	/* TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
   2129  1.8  christos   unsigned char tls_mask;
   2130  1.1  christos 
   2131  1.1  christos   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
   2132  1.1  christos      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
   2133  1.5  christos #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   2134  1.5  christos #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
   2135  1.5  christos #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
   2136  1.5  christos 
   2137  1.5  christos   /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
   2138  1.1  christos      symbol.  */
   2139  1.1  christos   unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
   2140  1.1  christos 
   2141  1.1  christos   /* Flag use of given relocations.  */
   2142  1.1  christos   unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
   2143  1.1  christos   unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
   2144  1.1  christos };
   2145  1.1  christos 
   2146  1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
   2147  1.1  christos 
   2148  1.3  christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2149  1.3  christos 
   2150  1.3  christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
   2151  1.1  christos {
   2152  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
   2153  1.1  christos 
   2154  1.1  christos   /* Various options passed from the linker.  */
   2155  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_params *params;
   2156  1.1  christos 
   2157  1.1  christos   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
   2158  1.8  christos   asection *glink;
   2159  1.8  christos   asection *dynsbss;
   2160  1.1  christos   asection *relsbss;
   2161  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
   2162  1.1  christos   asection *sbss;
   2163  1.1  christos   asection *glink_eh_frame;
   2164  1.1  christos   asection *pltlocal;
   2165  1.1  christos   asection *relpltlocal;
   2166  1.1  christos 
   2167  1.1  christos   /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks.  */
   2168  1.1  christos   asection *srelplt2;
   2169  1.1  christos 
   2170  1.1  christos   /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr.  */
   2171  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
   2172  1.1  christos 
   2173  1.1  christos   /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT.  */
   2174  1.1  christos   bfd *old_bfd;
   2175  1.1  christos 
   2176  1.1  christos   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  */
   2177  1.1  christos   union {
   2178  1.1  christos     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2179  1.1  christos     bfd_vma offset;
   2180  1.1  christos   } tlsld_got;
   2181  1.1  christos 
   2182  1.1  christos   /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink.  */
   2183  1.1  christos   bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
   2184  1.1  christos 
   2185  1.1  christos   /* Size of reserved GOT entries.  */
   2186  1.1  christos   unsigned int got_header_size;
   2187  1.1  christos   /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap.  */
   2188  1.1  christos   unsigned int got_gap;
   2189  1.1  christos 
   2190  1.7  christos   /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use.  */
   2191  1.7  christos   enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
   2192  1.7  christos 
   2193  1.7  christos   /* True if the target system is VxWorks.  */
   2194  1.7  christos   unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
   2195  1.8  christos 
   2196  1.8  christos   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
   2197  1.8  christos      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
   2198  1.8  christos   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2199  1.8  christos   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2200  1.8  christos 
   2201  1.1  christos   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
   2202  1.1  christos   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
   2203  1.1  christos 
   2204  1.1  christos   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
   2205  1.1  christos   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
   2206  1.1  christos 
   2207  1.1  christos   /* The size of PLT entries.  */
   2208  1.1  christos   int plt_entry_size;
   2209  1.1  christos   /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots.  */
   2210  1.1  christos   int plt_slot_size;
   2211  1.1  christos   /* The size of the first PLT entry.  */
   2212  1.1  christos   int plt_initial_entry_size;
   2213  1.1  christos 
   2214  1.1  christos   /* Small local sym cache.  */
   2215  1.1  christos   struct sym_cache sym_cache;
   2216  1.1  christos };
   2217  1.1  christos 
   2218  1.1  christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
   2219  1.1  christos    are used for ppc32.  The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects.  */
   2220  1.1  christos 
   2221  1.8  christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
   2222  1.8  christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
   2223  1.8  christos 
   2224  1.1  christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr.  */
   2225  1.1  christos #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
   2226  1.1  christos 
   2227  1.1  christos   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
   2228  1.1  christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
   2229  1.1  christos 
   2230  1.1  christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
   2231  1.1  christos 
   2232  1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
   2233  1.1  christos   (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
   2234  1.1  christos   == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
   2235  1.1  christos 
   2236  1.1  christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2237  1.1  christos 
   2238  1.1  christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
   2239  1.1  christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
   2240  1.1  christos 			   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
   2241  1.1  christos 			   const char *string)
   2242  1.1  christos {
   2243  1.1  christos   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
   2244  1.1  christos      subclass.  */
   2245  1.1  christos   if (entry == NULL)
   2246  1.1  christos     {
   2247  1.1  christos       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
   2248  1.1  christos 				 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
   2249  1.1  christos       if (entry == NULL)
   2250  1.1  christos 	return entry;
   2251  1.1  christos     }
   2252  1.1  christos 
   2253  1.1  christos   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
   2254  1.1  christos   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
   2255  1.1  christos   if (entry != NULL)
   2256  1.1  christos     {
   2257  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
   2258  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   2259  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
   2260  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
   2261  1.1  christos     }
   2262  1.1  christos 
   2263  1.1  christos   return entry;
   2264  1.1  christos }
   2265  1.1  christos 
   2266  1.6  christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2267  1.8  christos 
   2268  1.1  christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   2269  1.1  christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   2270  1.1  christos {
   2271  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
   2272  1.1  christos   static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
   2273  1.1  christos     = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
   2274  1.1  christos 
   2275  1.1  christos   ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
   2276  1.1  christos   if (ret == NULL)
   2277  1.1  christos     return NULL;
   2278  1.1  christos 
   2279  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
   2280  1.1  christos 				      ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
   2281  1.1  christos 				      sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
   2282  1.1  christos 				      PPC32_ELF_DATA))
   2283  1.1  christos     {
   2284  1.1  christos       free (ret);
   2285  1.1  christos       return NULL;
   2286  1.1  christos     }
   2287  1.3  christos 
   2288  1.3  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
   2289  1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
   2290  1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
   2291  1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
   2292  1.1  christos 
   2293  1.1  christos   ret->params = &default_params;
   2294  1.1  christos 
   2295  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
   2296  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
   2297  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
   2298  1.1  christos 
   2299  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
   2300  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
   2301  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
   2302  1.1  christos 
   2303  1.1  christos   ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
   2304  1.3  christos   ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
   2305  1.3  christos   ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
   2306  1.3  christos 
   2307  1.3  christos   return &ret->elf.root;
   2308  1.3  christos }
   2309  1.3  christos 
   2310  1.3  christos /* Hook linker params into hash table.  */
   2311  1.3  christos 
   2312  1.3  christos void
   2313  1.6  christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
   2314  1.3  christos {
   2315  1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2316  1.1  christos 
   2317  1.1  christos   if (htab)
   2318  1.1  christos     htab->params = params;
   2319  1.1  christos   params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
   2320  1.1  christos }
   2321  1.1  christos 
   2322  1.1  christos /* Create .got and the related sections.  */
   2323  1.1  christos 
   2324  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2325  1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2326  1.1  christos {
   2327  1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2328  1.1  christos 
   2329  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
   2330  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2331  1.7  christos 
   2332  1.7  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2333  1.7  christos   if (!htab->is_vxworks)
   2334  1.1  christos     {
   2335  1.1  christos       /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it.  Mark it
   2336  1.1  christos 	 executable.  */
   2337  1.1  christos       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2338  1.1  christos 			| SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2339  1.1  christos       if (!bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   2340  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   2341  1.3  christos     }
   2342  1.3  christos 
   2343  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   2344  1.3  christos }
   2345  1.3  christos 
   2346  1.3  christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
   2347  1.3  christos    R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers.  These sections become part of .sdata
   2348  1.3  christos    and .sdata2.  Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too.  */
   2349  1.3  christos 
   2350  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   2351  1.3  christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2352  1.3  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2353  1.3  christos 			       flagword flags,
   2354  1.3  christos 			       elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2355  1.3  christos {
   2356  1.3  christos   asection *s;
   2357  1.3  christos 
   2358  1.3  christos   flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
   2359  1.3  christos 	    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2360  1.3  christos 
   2361  1.3  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
   2362  1.3  christos   if (s == NULL)
   2363  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   2364  1.3  christos   lsect->section = s;
   2365  1.3  christos 
   2366  1.3  christos   /* Define the sym on the first section of this name.  */
   2367  1.3  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
   2368  1.3  christos 
   2369  1.3  christos   lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
   2370  1.1  christos   if (lsect->sym == NULL)
   2371  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2372  1.1  christos   lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
   2373  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2374  1.1  christos }
   2375  1.1  christos 
   2376  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   2377  1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2378  1.1  christos {
   2379  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2380  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   2381  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   2382  1.8  christos   int p2align;
   2383  1.8  christos 
   2384  1.8  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2385  1.1  christos 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2386  1.8  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
   2387  1.1  christos   htab->glink = s;
   2388  1.1  christos   p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
   2389  1.1  christos   if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
   2390  1.1  christos     p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
   2391  1.1  christos   if (s == NULL
   2392  1.1  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, p2align))
   2393  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2394  1.1  christos 
   2395  1.1  christos   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
   2396  1.1  christos     {
   2397  1.1  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2398  1.1  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2399  1.1  christos       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
   2400  1.1  christos       htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
   2401  1.1  christos       if (s == NULL
   2402  1.7  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
   2403  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2404  1.1  christos     }
   2405  1.1  christos 
   2406  1.1  christos   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2407  1.1  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
   2408  1.1  christos   htab->elf.iplt = s;
   2409  1.1  christos   if (s == NULL
   2410  1.7  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
   2411  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2412  1.1  christos 
   2413  1.1  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2414  1.3  christos 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2415  1.8  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
   2416  1.8  christos   htab->elf.irelplt = s;
   2417  1.8  christos   if (s == NULL
   2418  1.8  christos       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
   2419  1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   2420  1.8  christos 
   2421  1.8  christos   /* Local plt entries.  */
   2422  1.8  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
   2423  1.8  christos 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2424  1.8  christos   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
   2425  1.8  christos 						       flags);
   2426  1.8  christos   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
   2427  1.8  christos       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->pltlocal, 2))
   2428  1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   2429  1.8  christos 
   2430  1.8  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   2431  1.8  christos     {
   2432  1.8  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
   2433  1.8  christos 	       | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2434  1.8  christos       htab->relpltlocal
   2435  1.3  christos 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
   2436  1.3  christos       if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
   2437  1.3  christos 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->relpltlocal, 2))
   2438  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   2439  1.3  christos     }
   2440  1.3  christos 
   2441  1.3  christos   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
   2442  1.3  christos 				      &htab->sdata[0]))
   2443  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2444  1.1  christos 
   2445  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
   2446  1.1  christos 				      &htab->sdata[1]))
   2447  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2448  1.1  christos 
   2449  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2450  1.1  christos }
   2451  1.1  christos 
   2452  1.1  christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
   2453  1.1  christos    to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
   2454  1.1  christos    to create .dynbss and .rela.bss).  */
   2455  1.1  christos 
   2456  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2457  1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2458  1.1  christos {
   2459  1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2460  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   2461  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   2462  1.1  christos 
   2463  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2464  1.1  christos 
   2465  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2466  1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
   2467  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2468  1.1  christos 
   2469  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
   2470  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2471  1.1  christos 
   2472  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink == NULL
   2473  1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
   2474  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2475  1.1  christos 
   2476  1.6  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
   2477  1.1  christos 					  SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2478  1.1  christos   htab->dynsbss = s;
   2479  1.1  christos   if (s == NULL)
   2480  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2481  1.1  christos 
   2482  1.1  christos   if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   2483  1.1  christos     {
   2484  1.1  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2485  1.1  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2486  1.1  christos       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
   2487  1.1  christos       htab->relsbss = s;
   2488  1.1  christos       if (s == NULL
   2489  1.1  christos 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
   2490  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2491  1.7  christos     }
   2492  1.1  christos 
   2493  1.1  christos   if (htab->is_vxworks
   2494  1.1  christos       && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
   2495  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2496  1.1  christos 
   2497  1.1  christos   s = htab->elf.splt;
   2498  1.1  christos   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2499  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   2500  1.1  christos     /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents.  */
   2501  1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
   2502  1.1  christos   return bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags);
   2503  1.1  christos }
   2504  1.1  christos 
   2505  1.1  christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
   2506  1.1  christos 
   2507  1.1  christos static void
   2508  1.1  christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2509  1.1  christos 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
   2510  1.1  christos 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
   2511  1.1  christos {
   2512  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
   2513  1.1  christos 
   2514  1.7  christos   edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
   2515  1.7  christos   eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
   2516  1.1  christos 
   2517  1.1  christos   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
   2518  1.8  christos   edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
   2519  1.1  christos 
   2520  1.1  christos   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
   2521  1.1  christos     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
   2522  1.8  christos   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
   2523  1.8  christos   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
   2524  1.8  christos   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
   2525  1.8  christos   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
   2526  1.1  christos   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
   2527  1.1  christos 
   2528  1.1  christos   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all.  */
   2529  1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   2530  1.1  christos     return;
   2531  1.1  christos 
   2532  1.1  christos   if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2533  1.1  christos     {
   2534  1.1  christos       if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2535  1.1  christos 	{
   2536  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   2537  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   2538  1.1  christos 
   2539  1.1  christos 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
   2540  1.1  christos 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
   2541  1.1  christos 	  for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   2542  1.1  christos 	    {
   2543  1.1  christos 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
   2544  1.1  christos 
   2545  1.1  christos 	      for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
   2546  1.1  christos 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
   2547  1.1  christos 		  {
   2548  1.1  christos 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
   2549  1.1  christos 		    q->count += p->count;
   2550  1.1  christos 		    *pp = p->next;
   2551  1.1  christos 		    break;
   2552  1.1  christos 		  }
   2553  1.1  christos 	      if (q == NULL)
   2554  1.1  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   2555  1.1  christos 	    }
   2556  1.1  christos 	  *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
   2557  1.1  christos 	}
   2558  1.1  christos 
   2559  1.1  christos       edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
   2560  1.1  christos       eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   2561  1.1  christos     }
   2562  1.1  christos 
   2563  1.1  christos   /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
   2564  1.1  christos      the symbol which just became indirect.  */
   2565  1.1  christos   edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
   2566  1.1  christos   eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
   2567  1.1  christos 
   2568  1.1  christos   /* And plt entries.  */
   2569  1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2570  1.1  christos     {
   2571  1.1  christos       if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2572  1.1  christos 	{
   2573  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
   2574  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   2575  1.1  christos 
   2576  1.1  christos 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
   2577  1.1  christos 	    {
   2578  1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
   2579  1.1  christos 
   2580  1.1  christos 	      for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
   2581  1.1  christos 		if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
   2582  1.1  christos 		  {
   2583  1.1  christos 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
   2584  1.1  christos 		    *entp = ent->next;
   2585  1.1  christos 		    break;
   2586  1.1  christos 		  }
   2587  1.1  christos 	      if (dent == NULL)
   2588  1.1  christos 		entp = &ent->next;
   2589  1.1  christos 	    }
   2590  1.1  christos 	  *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
   2591  1.1  christos 	}
   2592  1.1  christos 
   2593  1.1  christos       edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
   2594  1.1  christos       eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
   2595  1.1  christos     }
   2596  1.1  christos 
   2597  1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2598  1.1  christos     {
   2599  1.1  christos       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2600  1.1  christos 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   2601  1.1  christos 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
   2602  1.1  christos       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
   2603  1.1  christos       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
   2604  1.1  christos       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
   2605  1.1  christos       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
   2606  1.1  christos     }
   2607  1.1  christos }
   2608  1.1  christos 
   2609  1.1  christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
   2610  1.1  christos    file.  We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss.  */
   2611  1.1  christos 
   2612  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2613  1.1  christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   2614  1.1  christos 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2615  1.1  christos 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   2616  1.6  christos 			 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2617  1.1  christos 			 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2618  1.1  christos 			 asection **secp,
   2619  1.1  christos 			 bfd_vma *valp)
   2620  1.1  christos {
   2621  1.1  christos   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
   2622  1.1  christos       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   2623  1.1  christos       && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
   2624  1.1  christos       && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
   2625  1.1  christos     {
   2626  1.1  christos       /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
   2627  1.1  christos 	 put into .sbss.  */
   2628  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2629  1.1  christos 
   2630  1.1  christos       htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2631  1.1  christos       if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2632  1.1  christos 	{
   2633  1.1  christos 	  flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2634  1.1  christos 
   2635  1.1  christos 	  if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
   2636  1.1  christos 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2637  1.1  christos 
   2638  1.1  christos 	  htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
   2639  1.1  christos 							   ".sbss",
   2640  1.1  christos 							   flags);
   2641  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2642  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2643  1.1  christos 	}
   2644  1.1  christos 
   2645  1.1  christos       *secp = htab->sbss;
   2646  1.1  christos       *valp = sym->st_size;
   2647  1.1  christos     }
   2648  1.1  christos 
   2649  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2650  1.1  christos }
   2651  1.1  christos 
   2652  1.1  christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type.  */
   2654  1.1  christos 
   2655  1.1  christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
   2656  1.1  christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
   2657  1.1  christos   (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
   2658  1.1  christos    bfd_vma addend,
   2659  1.1  christos    elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2660  1.1  christos {
   2661  1.1  christos   for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
   2662  1.1  christos     if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
   2663  1.1  christos       return linker_pointers;
   2664  1.3  christos 
   2665  1.3  christos   return NULL;
   2666  1.3  christos }
   2667  1.3  christos 
   2668  1.1  christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section.  */
   2669  1.1  christos 
   2670  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2671  1.1  christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2672  1.1  christos 				     elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   2673  1.1  christos 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   2674  1.1  christos 				     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   2675  1.1  christos {
   2676  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
   2677  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   2678  1.1  christos   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2679  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type amt;
   2680  1.1  christos 
   2681  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   2682  1.1  christos 
   2683  1.1  christos   /* Is this a global symbol?  */
   2684  1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   2685  1.1  christos     {
   2686  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   2687  1.1  christos 
   2688  1.1  christos       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2689  1.1  christos       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   2690  1.1  christos       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
   2691  1.1  christos 					   rel->r_addend,
   2692  1.1  christos 					   lsect))
   2693  1.1  christos 	return TRUE;
   2694  1.1  christos 
   2695  1.1  christos       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
   2696  1.1  christos     }
   2697  1.1  christos   else
   2698  1.1  christos     {
   2699  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2700  1.1  christos 
   2701  1.1  christos       /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol.  */
   2702  1.1  christos       elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
   2703  1.1  christos 
   2704  1.1  christos       /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time.  */
   2705  1.1  christos       if (!ptr)
   2706  1.1  christos 	{
   2707  1.1  christos 	  unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
   2708  1.1  christos 
   2709  1.1  christos 	  amt = num_symbols;
   2710  1.1  christos 	  amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
   2711  1.1  christos 	  ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   2712  1.1  christos 
   2713  1.1  christos 	  if (!ptr)
   2714  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2715  1.1  christos 
   2716  1.1  christos 	  elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
   2717  1.1  christos 	}
   2718  1.1  christos 
   2719  1.1  christos       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2720  1.1  christos       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
   2721  1.1  christos 					   rel->r_addend,
   2722  1.1  christos 					   lsect))
   2723  1.1  christos 	return TRUE;
   2724  1.1  christos 
   2725  1.1  christos       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
   2726  1.1  christos     }
   2727  1.1  christos 
   2728  1.1  christos   /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
   2729  1.1  christos      a new pointer record from internal memory.  */
   2730  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   2731  1.1  christos   amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
   2732  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2733  1.1  christos 
   2734  1.1  christos   if (!linker_section_ptr)
   2735  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   2736  1.3  christos 
   2737  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
   2738  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
   2739  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
   2740  1.1  christos   *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
   2741  1.1  christos 
   2742  1.1  christos   if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section->owner, lsect->section, 2))
   2743  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2744  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
   2745  1.1  christos   lsect->section->size += 4;
   2746  1.1  christos 
   2747  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   2748  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr,
   2749  1.1  christos 	   "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
   2750  1.1  christos 	   lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
   2751  1.1  christos 	   (long) lsect->section->size);
   2752  1.1  christos #endif
   2753  1.1  christos 
   2754  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2755  1.1  christos }
   2756  1.1  christos 
   2757  1.1  christos static struct plt_entry **
   2758  1.8  christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
   2759  1.1  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
   2760  1.1  christos 		       unsigned long r_symndx,
   2761  1.1  christos 		       int tls_type)
   2762  1.1  christos {
   2763  1.1  christos   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
   2764  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   2765  1.1  christos   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
   2766  1.1  christos 
   2767  1.1  christos   if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2768  1.1  christos     {
   2769  1.1  christos       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   2770  1.1  christos 
   2771  1.1  christos       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
   2772  1.1  christos 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
   2773  1.1  christos 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
   2774  1.8  christos       local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
   2775  1.8  christos       if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2776  1.8  christos 	return NULL;
   2777  1.1  christos       elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
   2778  1.1  christos     }
   2779  1.1  christos 
   2780  1.1  christos   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2781  1.1  christos   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2782  1.1  christos   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
   2783  1.1  christos   if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
   2784  1.1  christos     local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
   2785  1.1  christos   return local_plt + r_symndx;
   2786  1.1  christos }
   2787  1.1  christos 
   2788  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2789  1.1  christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
   2790  1.1  christos 		 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2791  1.1  christos {
   2792  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2793  1.1  christos 
   2794  1.1  christos   if (addend < 32768)
   2795  1.1  christos     sec = NULL;
   2796  1.1  christos   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2797  1.1  christos     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2798  1.1  christos       break;
   2799  1.1  christos   if (ent == NULL)
   2800  1.1  christos     {
   2801  1.1  christos       bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
   2802  1.1  christos       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2803  1.1  christos       if (ent == NULL)
   2804  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2805  1.1  christos       ent->next = *plist;
   2806  1.1  christos       ent->sec = sec;
   2807  1.1  christos       ent->addend = addend;
   2808  1.1  christos       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
   2809  1.1  christos       *plist = ent;
   2810  1.1  christos     }
   2811  1.1  christos   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
   2812  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2813  1.1  christos }
   2814  1.1  christos 
   2815  1.1  christos static struct plt_entry *
   2816  1.1  christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2817  1.1  christos {
   2818  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2819  1.1  christos 
   2820  1.1  christos   if (addend < 32768)
   2821  1.1  christos     sec = NULL;
   2822  1.1  christos   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2823  1.1  christos     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2824  1.1  christos       break;
   2825  1.1  christos   return ent;
   2826  1.1  christos }
   2827  1.1  christos 
   2828  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2829  1.1  christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2830  1.1  christos {
   2831  1.1  christos   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   2832  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
   2833  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
   2834  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
   2835  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   2836  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
   2837  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
   2838  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
   2839  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
   2840  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
   2841  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
   2842  1.8  christos }
   2843  1.8  christos 
   2844  1.8  christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
   2845  1.8  christos 
   2846  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   2847  1.8  christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2848  1.1  christos {
   2849  1.1  christos   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
   2850  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2851  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2852  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
   2853  1.8  christos }
   2854  1.1  christos 
   2855  1.1  christos static void
   2856  1.1  christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2857  1.1  christos {
   2858  1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler
   2859  1.1  christos     /* xgettext:c-format */
   2860  1.1  christos     (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
   2861  1.1  christos      abfd,
   2862  1.1  christos      ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
   2863  1.1  christos   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   2864  1.1  christos }
   2865  1.1  christos 
   2866  1.1  christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
   2867  1.1  christos    allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
   2868  1.1  christos    table.  */
   2869  1.1  christos 
   2870  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2871  1.1  christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   2872  1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2873  1.1  christos 		      asection *sec,
   2874  1.1  christos 		      const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
   2875  1.1  christos {
   2876  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2877  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2878  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   2879  1.1  christos   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   2880  1.1  christos   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
   2881  1.1  christos   asection *got2, *sreloc;
   2882  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
   2883  1.1  christos 
   2884  1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   2885  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   2886  1.1  christos 
   2887  1.1  christos   /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
   2888  1.1  christos      In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
   2889  1.1  christos      and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
   2890  1.8  christos      or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
   2891  1.1  christos      relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
   2892  1.1  christos      libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate.  */
   2893  1.1  christos   if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
   2894  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   2895  1.1  christos 
   2896  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   2897  1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
   2898  1.1  christos 		      sec, abfd);
   2899  1.1  christos #endif
   2900  1.1  christos 
   2901  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2902  1.1  christos 
   2903  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   2904  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   2905  1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   2906  1.1  christos 
   2907  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2908  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink == NULL)
   2909  1.1  christos     {
   2910  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2911  1.1  christos 	htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2912  1.1  christos       if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2913  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2914  1.1  christos     }
   2915  1.1  christos   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   2916  1.1  christos 			      FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   2917  1.1  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   2918  1.1  christos   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
   2919  1.1  christos   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   2920  1.1  christos   sreloc = NULL;
   2921  1.1  christos 
   2922  1.6  christos   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
   2923  1.8  christos   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
   2924  1.8  christos     {
   2925  1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx;
   2926  1.1  christos       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   2927  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   2928  1.1  christos       int tls_type;
   2929  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **ifunc;
   2930  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **pltent;
   2931  1.1  christos       bfd_vma addend;
   2932  1.1  christos 
   2933  1.1  christos       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2934  1.1  christos       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   2935  1.1  christos 	h = NULL;
   2936  1.1  christos       else
   2937  1.1  christos 	{
   2938  1.1  christos 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   2939  1.1  christos 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   2940  1.1  christos 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   2941  1.7  christos 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   2942  1.1  christos 	}
   2943  1.1  christos 
   2944  1.1  christos       /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
   2945  1.1  christos 	 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
   2946  1.1  christos 	 startup code.  */
   2947  1.1  christos       if (h != NULL
   2948  1.1  christos 	  && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2949  1.1  christos 	  && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
   2950  1.1  christos 	{
   2951  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2952  1.1  christos 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2953  1.6  christos 	  if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2954  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2955  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
   2956  1.1  christos 	}
   2957  1.1  christos 
   2958  1.1  christos       tls_type = 0;
   2959  1.1  christos       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   2960  1.1  christos       ifunc = NULL;
   2961  1.1  christos       if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
   2962  1.1  christos 	{
   2963  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
   2964  1.1  christos 							  abfd, r_symndx);
   2965  1.8  christos 	  if (isym == NULL)
   2966  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2967  1.1  christos 
   2968  1.1  christos 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   2969  1.1  christos 	    {
   2970  1.1  christos 	      /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet.  */
   2971  1.1  christos 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   2972  1.6  christos 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
   2973  1.8  christos 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
   2974  1.8  christos 		return FALSE;
   2975  1.8  christos 
   2976  1.8  christos 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
   2977  1.1  christos 		 In a non-pie executable even when there are
   2978  1.8  christos 		 no plt calls.  */
   2979  1.1  christos 	      if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   2980  1.8  christos 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   2981  1.8  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2982  1.8  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2983  1.8  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
   2984  1.8  christos 		{
   2985  1.8  christos 		  addend = 0;
   2986  1.8  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   2987  1.1  christos 		    ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   2988  1.1  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   2989  1.1  christos 		      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   2990  1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2991  1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2992  1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   2993  1.1  christos 		    addend = rel->r_addend;
   2994  1.1  christos 		  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
   2995  1.1  christos 		    return FALSE;
   2996  1.1  christos 		}
   2997  1.1  christos 	    }
   2998  1.1  christos 	}
   2999  1.1  christos 
   3000  1.1  christos       if (!htab->is_vxworks
   3001  1.1  christos 	  && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   3002  1.1  christos 	  && h != NULL
   3003  1.1  christos 	  && h == tga)
   3004  1.1  christos 	{
   3005  1.1  christos 	  if (rel != relocs
   3006  1.1  christos 	      && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
   3007  1.1  christos 		  || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
   3008  1.1  christos 	    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
   3009  1.1  christos 	       reloc.  */
   3010  1.1  christos 	    ;
   3011  1.1  christos 	  else
   3012  1.1  christos 	    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
   3013  1.1  christos 	    sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
   3014  1.1  christos 	}
   3015  1.8  christos 
   3016  1.8  christos       switch (r_type)
   3017  1.8  christos 	{
   3018  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   3019  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   3020  1.8  christos 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
   3021  1.8  christos 	     its parameter symbol.  */
   3022  1.8  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3023  1.8  christos 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
   3024  1.1  christos 	  else
   3025  1.1  christos 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3026  1.1  christos 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   3027  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3028  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3029  1.1  christos 
   3030  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   3031  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3032  1.1  christos 
   3033  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   3034  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   3035  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   3036  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   3037  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   3038  1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3039  1.1  christos 
   3040  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   3041  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   3042  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   3043  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   3044  1.8  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   3045  1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3046  1.1  christos 
   3047  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   3048  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   3049  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   3050  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   3051  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3052  1.1  christos 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3053  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   3054  1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3055  1.1  christos 
   3056  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   3057  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   3058  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   3059  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   3060  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   3061  1.1  christos 	dogottls:
   3062  1.1  christos 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3063  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3064  1.7  christos 
   3065  1.1  christos 	  /* GOT16 relocations */
   3066  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   3067  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   3068  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   3069  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   3070  1.1  christos 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
   3071  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   3072  1.1  christos 	    {
   3073  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3074  1.1  christos 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3075  1.1  christos 	      if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   3076  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3077  1.1  christos 	    }
   3078  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3079  1.1  christos 	    {
   3080  1.1  christos 	      h->got.refcount += 1;
   3081  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
   3082  1.1  christos 	    }
   3083  1.6  christos 	  else
   3084  1.1  christos 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
   3085  1.1  christos 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
   3086  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3087  1.1  christos 
   3088  1.1  christos 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3089  1.1  christos 	     an ifunc.  */
   3090  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3091  1.1  christos 	    {
   3092  1.6  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3093  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3094  1.1  christos 	    }
   3095  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3096  1.1  christos 
   3097  1.3  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   3098  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   3099  1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   3100  1.1  christos 	    {
   3101  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3102  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3103  1.1  christos 	    }
   3104  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3105  1.1  christos 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   3106  1.1  christos 						    h, rel))
   3107  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3108  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3109  1.1  christos 	    {
   3110  1.6  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3111  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3112  1.1  christos 	    }
   3113  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3114  1.1  christos 
   3115  1.3  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   3116  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   3117  1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   3118  1.1  christos 	    {
   3119  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3120  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3121  1.1  christos 	    }
   3122  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3123  1.1  christos 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   3124  1.1  christos 						    h, rel))
   3125  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3126  1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3127  1.3  christos 	    {
   3128  1.7  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3129  1.3  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3130  1.1  christos 	    }
   3131  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3132  1.1  christos 
   3133  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   3134  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3135  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3136  1.1  christos 
   3137  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   3138  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   3139  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   3140  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   3141  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   3142  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   3143  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3144  1.1  christos 	    {
   3145  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3146  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3147  1.1  christos 	    }
   3148  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3149  1.1  christos 
   3150  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   3151  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   3152  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   3153  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   3154  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   3155  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   3156  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   3157  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   3158  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   3159  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   3160  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3161  1.3  christos 
   3162  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   3163  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   3164  1.1  christos 	    {
   3165  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3166  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3167  1.1  christos 	    }
   3168  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3169  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3170  1.1  christos 	    {
   3171  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3172  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3173  1.6  christos 	    }
   3174  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3175  1.1  christos 
   3176  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   3177  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   3178  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   3179  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   3180  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   3181  1.1  christos 	    {
   3182  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3183  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3184  1.1  christos 	    }
   3185  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3186  1.1  christos 	    {
   3187  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3188  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3189  1.1  christos 	    }
   3190  1.6  christos 	  break;
   3191  1.1  christos 
   3192  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   3193  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   3194  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   3195  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   3196  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   3197  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   3198  1.1  christos 	    {
   3199  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3200  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3201  1.1  christos 	    }
   3202  1.8  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3203  1.8  christos 	    h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3204  1.8  christos 	  break;
   3205  1.8  christos 
   3206  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   3207  1.8  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3208  1.8  christos 	    break;
   3209  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   3210  1.1  christos 	  goto pltentry;
   3211  1.1  christos 
   3212  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   3213  1.1  christos 	  sec->has_pltcall = 1;
   3214  1.8  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3215  1.1  christos 
   3216  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   3217  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   3218  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   3219  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   3220  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   3221  1.8  christos 	pltentry:
   3222  1.8  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   3223  1.8  christos 	  fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
   3224  1.8  christos #endif
   3225  1.1  christos 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
   3226  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3227  1.1  christos 	    {
   3228  1.8  christos 	      pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3229  1.8  christos 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
   3230  1.1  christos 	      if (pltent == NULL)
   3231  1.8  christos 		return FALSE;
   3232  1.1  christos 	    }
   3233  1.8  christos 	  else
   3234  1.8  christos 	    {
   3235  1.8  christos 	      if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   3236  1.8  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
   3237  1.8  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3238  1.8  christos 	      pltent = &h->plt.plist;
   3239  1.8  christos 	    }
   3240  1.8  christos 	  addend = 0;
   3241  1.8  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3242  1.1  christos 	      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   3243  1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   3244  1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   3245  1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   3246  1.1  christos 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
   3247  1.1  christos 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
   3248  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3249  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3250  1.1  christos 
   3251  1.1  christos 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
   3252  1.1  christos 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
   3253  1.1  christos 	     section relative.  */
   3254  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   3255  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   3256  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   3257  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   3258  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   3259  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   3260  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   3261  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   3262  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_TOC16:
   3263  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3264  1.1  christos 
   3265  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   3266  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   3267  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   3268  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   3269  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   3270  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
   3271  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3272  1.1  christos 
   3273  1.1  christos 	  /* These are just markers.  */
   3274  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   3275  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   3276  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   3277  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_max:
   3278  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   3279  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   3280  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   3281  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
   3282  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3283  1.1  christos 
   3284  1.1  christos 	  /* These should only appear in dynamic objects.  */
   3285  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   3286  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   3287  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   3288  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   3289  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   3290  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3291  1.1  christos 
   3292  1.1  christos 	  /* These aren't handled yet.  We'll report an error later.  */
   3293  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   3294  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   3295  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   3296  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   3297  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   3298  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   3299  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3300  1.1  christos 
   3301  1.3  christos 	  /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library.  */
   3302  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   3303  1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3304  1.3  christos 	    {
   3305  1.3  christos 	      htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3306  1.3  christos 	      htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3307  1.1  christos 	    }
   3308  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   3309  1.1  christos 	    {
   3310  1.1  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3311  1.1  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3312  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3313  1.1  christos 	    }
   3314  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3315  1.1  christos 
   3316  1.1  christos 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
   3317  1.1  christos 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
   3318  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   3319  1.1  christos 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
   3320  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3321  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3322  1.1  christos 
   3323  1.1  christos 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
   3324  1.1  christos 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
   3325  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   3326  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
   3327  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL
   3328  1.1  christos 	      && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
   3329  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3330  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3331  1.8  christos 
   3332  1.1  christos 	  /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32.  */
   3333  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   3334  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   3335  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   3336  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   3337  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   3338  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3339  1.1  christos 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3340  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3341  1.1  christos 
   3342  1.1  christos 	  /* Nor these.  */
   3343  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   3344  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   3345  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3346  1.1  christos 
   3347  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   3348  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL
   3349  1.1  christos 	      && got2 != NULL
   3350  1.1  christos 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
   3351  1.1  christos 	      && bfd_link_pic (info)
   3352  1.1  christos 	      && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3353  1.1  christos 	    {
   3354  1.1  christos 	      /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
   3355  1.1  christos 		 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
   3356  1.1  christos 		 reference to .got2.  If we detect one of these, then
   3357  1.1  christos 		 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
   3358  1.1  christos 		 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
   3359  1.1  christos 		 PLT call stubs.  */
   3360  1.1  christos 	      asection *s;
   3361  1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   3362  1.1  christos 
   3363  1.1  christos 	      isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
   3364  1.1  christos 					    abfd, r_symndx);
   3365  1.1  christos 	      if (isym == NULL)
   3366  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3367  1.1  christos 
   3368  1.1  christos 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3369  1.1  christos 	      if (s == got2)
   3370  1.1  christos 		{
   3371  1.1  christos 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3372  1.1  christos 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3373  1.1  christos 		}
   3374  1.1  christos 	    }
   3375  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3376  1.1  christos 	    break;
   3377  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   3378  1.1  christos 
   3379  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   3380  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   3381  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   3382  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   3383  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   3384  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   3385  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   3386  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3387  1.1  christos 	    {
   3388  1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3389  1.5  christos 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3390  1.5  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3391  1.5  christos 		return FALSE;
   3392  1.5  christos 
   3393  1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a copy reloc too.  */
   3394  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
   3395  1.1  christos 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
   3396  1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   3397  1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
   3398  1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
   3399  1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
   3400  1.1  christos 	    }
   3401  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3402  1.1  christos 
   3403  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   3404  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   3405  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   3406  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   3407  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3408  1.1  christos 	    break;
   3409  1.1  christos 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3410  1.1  christos 	    {
   3411  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3412  1.1  christos 		{
   3413  1.1  christos 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3414  1.1  christos 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3415  1.1  christos 		}
   3416  1.1  christos 	      break;
   3417  1.6  christos 	    }
   3418  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   3419  1.1  christos 
   3420  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   3421  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   3422  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   3423  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   3424  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3425  1.1  christos 	    {
   3426  1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3427  1.1  christos 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3428  1.1  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3429  1.1  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3430  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3431  1.1  christos 	      break;
   3432  1.1  christos 	    }
   3433  1.1  christos 
   3434  1.1  christos 	dodyn:
   3435  1.1  christos 	  /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
   3436  1.1  christos 	     against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
   3437  1.1  christos 	     against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
   3438  1.1  christos 	     into the shared library.  However, if we are linking with
   3439  1.1  christos 	     -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
   3440  1.1  christos 	     global symbol which is defined in an object we are
   3441  1.1  christos 	     including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set).  At
   3442  1.1  christos 	     this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
   3443  1.1  christos 	     possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
   3444  1.1  christos 	     later (it is never cleared).  In case of a weak definition,
   3445  1.1  christos 	     DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
   3446  1.1  christos 	     a shared library.  We account for that possibility below by
   3447  1.1  christos 	     storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
   3448  1.1  christos 	     table entry.  A similar situation occurs when creating
   3449  1.6  christos 	     shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
   3450  1.1  christos 	     symbol local.
   3451  1.1  christos 
   3452  1.1  christos 	     If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
   3453  1.1  christos 	     may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
   3454  1.1  christos 	     dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
   3455  1.1  christos 	     symbol.  */
   3456  1.6  christos 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
   3457  1.1  christos 	       && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
   3458  1.1  christos 		   || (h != NULL
   3459  1.1  christos 		       && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
   3460  1.1  christos 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
   3461  1.1  christos 			   || !h->def_regular))))
   3462  1.1  christos 	      || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   3463  1.1  christos 		  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
   3464  1.1  christos 		  && h != NULL
   3465  1.1  christos 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
   3466  1.1  christos 		      || !h->def_regular)))
   3467  1.1  christos 	    {
   3468  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   3469  1.1  christos 	      fprintf (stderr,
   3470  1.1  christos 		       "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
   3471  1.1  christos 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   3472  1.1  christos 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   3473  1.1  christos 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   3474  1.1  christos #endif
   3475  1.1  christos 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   3476  1.1  christos 		{
   3477  1.1  christos 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3478  1.1  christos 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3479  1.1  christos 
   3480  1.1  christos 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
   3481  1.1  christos 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
   3482  1.1  christos 
   3483  1.1  christos 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
   3484  1.1  christos 		    return FALSE;
   3485  1.1  christos 		}
   3486  1.1  christos 
   3487  1.1  christos 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
   3488  1.1  christos 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
   3489  1.1  christos 	      if (h != NULL)
   3490  1.1  christos 		{
   3491  1.1  christos 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   3492  1.1  christos 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3493  1.1  christos 
   3494  1.1  christos 		  rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
   3495  1.1  christos 		  p = *rel_head;
   3496  1.1  christos 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
   3497  1.1  christos 		    {
   3498  1.1  christos 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3499  1.1  christos 		      if (p == NULL)
   3500  1.1  christos 			return FALSE;
   3501  1.1  christos 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3502  1.1  christos 		      *rel_head = p;
   3503  1.1  christos 		      p->sec = sec;
   3504  1.1  christos 		      p->count = 0;
   3505  1.1  christos 		      p->pc_count = 0;
   3506  1.1  christos 		    }
   3507  1.1  christos 		  p->count += 1;
   3508  1.1  christos 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
   3509  1.1  christos 		    p->pc_count += 1;
   3510  1.1  christos 		}
   3511  1.1  christos 	      else
   3512  1.1  christos 		{
   3513  1.1  christos 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
   3514  1.1  christos 		     We really need local syms available to do this
   3515  1.1  christos 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
   3516  1.1  christos 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   3517  1.1  christos 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3518  1.1  christos 		  bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
   3519  1.1  christos 		  asection *s;
   3520  1.1  christos 		  void *vpp;
   3521  1.1  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   3522  1.1  christos 
   3523  1.1  christos 		  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
   3524  1.1  christos 						abfd, r_symndx);
   3525  1.1  christos 		  if (isym == NULL)
   3526  1.1  christos 		    return FALSE;
   3527  1.1  christos 
   3528  1.1  christos 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3529  1.1  christos 		  if (s == NULL)
   3530  1.1  christos 		    s = sec;
   3531  1.1  christos 
   3532  1.1  christos 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
   3533  1.1  christos 		  rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
   3534  1.1  christos 		  is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
   3535  1.1  christos 		  p = *rel_head;
   3536  1.1  christos 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3537  1.1  christos 		    p = p->next;
   3538  1.1  christos 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3539  1.1  christos 		    {
   3540  1.1  christos 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3541  1.1  christos 		      if (p == NULL)
   3542  1.1  christos 			return FALSE;
   3543  1.1  christos 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3544  1.1  christos 		      *rel_head = p;
   3545  1.1  christos 		      p->sec = sec;
   3546  1.1  christos 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
   3547  1.1  christos 		      p->count = 0;
   3548  1.1  christos 		    }
   3549  1.1  christos 		  p->count += 1;
   3550  1.1  christos 		}
   3551  1.1  christos 	    }
   3552  1.1  christos 
   3553  1.7  christos 	  break;
   3554  1.7  christos 	}
   3555  1.8  christos     }
   3556  1.7  christos 
   3557  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   3558  1.7  christos }
   3559  1.1  christos 
   3560  1.1  christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
   3562  1.1  christos    and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3563  1.1  christos bfd_boolean
   3564  1.1  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3565  1.1  christos {
   3566  1.1  christos   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3567  1.1  christos   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3568  1.7  christos   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3569  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   3570  1.1  christos 
   3571  1.7  christos   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3572  1.7  christos   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3573  1.8  christos 
   3574  1.7  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3575  1.7  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3576  1.1  christos 
   3577  1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3578  1.7  christos     {
   3579  1.8  christos       int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
   3580  1.7  christos       int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
   3581  1.8  christos       static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
   3582  1.7  christos 
   3583  1.7  christos       if (in_fp == 0)
   3584  1.8  christos 	;
   3585  1.8  christos       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3586  1.8  christos 	{
   3587  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3588  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3589  1.8  christos 	  last_fp = ibfd;
   3590  1.8  christos 	}
   3591  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
   3592  1.8  christos 	{
   3593  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3594  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3595  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3596  1.8  christos 	     last_fp, ibfd);
   3597  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3598  1.8  christos 	}
   3599  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
   3600  1.8  christos 	{
   3601  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3602  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3603  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3604  1.8  christos 	     ibfd, last_fp);
   3605  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3606  1.8  christos 	}
   3607  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
   3608  1.8  christos 	{
   3609  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3610  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3611  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3612  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
   3613  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3614  1.8  christos 	}
   3615  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
   3616  1.7  christos 	{
   3617  1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3618  1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3619  1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3620  1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
   3621  1.7  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3622  1.8  christos 	}
   3623  1.7  christos 
   3624  1.8  christos       in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
   3625  1.7  christos       out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
   3626  1.7  christos       if (in_fp == 0)
   3627  1.8  christos 	;
   3628  1.8  christos       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3629  1.8  christos 	{
   3630  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3631  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3632  1.8  christos 	  last_ld = ibfd;
   3633  1.8  christos 	}
   3634  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
   3635  1.8  christos 	{
   3636  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3637  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3638  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3639  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3640  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3641  1.8  christos 	}
   3642  1.7  christos       else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
   3643  1.8  christos 	{
   3644  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3645  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3646  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3647  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3648  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3649  1.8  christos 	}
   3650  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
   3651  1.8  christos 	{
   3652  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3653  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3654  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3655  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3656  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3657  1.8  christos 	}
   3658  1.8  christos       else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
   3659  1.8  christos 	{
   3660  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3661  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3662  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3663  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3664  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3665  1.8  christos 	}
   3666  1.7  christos     }
   3667  1.7  christos 
   3668  1.7  christos   if (!ret)
   3669  1.7  christos     {
   3670  1.7  christos       out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3671  1.7  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3672  1.7  christos     }
   3673  1.7  christos   return ret;
   3674  1.7  christos }
   3675  1.7  christos 
   3676  1.8  christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Warn if
   3677  1.7  christos    there are conflicting attributes.  */
   3678  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   3679  1.8  christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3680  1.7  christos {
   3681  1.7  christos   bfd *obfd;
   3682  1.7  christos   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3683  1.7  christos   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3684  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean ret;
   3685  1.1  christos 
   3686  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3687  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   3688  1.1  christos 
   3689  1.8  christos   obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3690  1.1  christos   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3691  1.1  christos   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3692  1.7  christos 
   3693  1.7  christos   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
   3694  1.8  christos      merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3695  1.1  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3696  1.7  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3697  1.7  christos   ret = TRUE;
   3698  1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3699  1.1  christos     {
   3700  1.8  christos       int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
   3701  1.7  christos       int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
   3702  1.8  christos       static bfd *last_vec;
   3703  1.1  christos 
   3704  1.1  christos       if (in_vec == 0)
   3705  1.1  christos 	;
   3706  1.1  christos       else if (out_vec == 0)
   3707  1.1  christos 	{
   3708  1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3709  1.7  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3710  1.1  christos 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3711  1.7  christos 	}
   3712  1.7  christos       /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
   3713  1.8  christos 	 without a warning.  If GCC marked files with their stack
   3714  1.7  christos 	 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
   3715  1.8  christos 	 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
   3716  1.7  christos 	 case too.  */
   3717  1.7  christos       else if (in_vec == 1)
   3718  1.8  christos 	;
   3719  1.8  christos       else if (out_vec == 1)
   3720  1.8  christos 	{
   3721  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3722  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3723  1.8  christos 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3724  1.8  christos 	}
   3725  1.8  christos       else if (out_vec < in_vec)
   3726  1.7  christos 	{
   3727  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3728  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3729  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3730  1.8  christos 	     last_vec, ibfd);
   3731  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3732  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3733  1.8  christos 	}
   3734  1.8  christos       else if (out_vec > in_vec)
   3735  1.1  christos 	{
   3736  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3737  1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3738  1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3739  1.1  christos 	     ibfd, last_vec);
   3740  1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3741  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3742  1.1  christos 	}
   3743  1.7  christos     }
   3744  1.7  christos 
   3745  1.8  christos   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
   3746  1.7  christos      and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3747  1.7  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3748  1.1  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3749  1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3750  1.7  christos     {
   3751  1.8  christos       int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
   3752  1.7  christos       int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
   3753  1.8  christos       static bfd *last_struct;
   3754  1.7  christos 
   3755  1.7  christos       if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
   3756  1.8  christos        ;
   3757  1.8  christos       else if (out_struct == 0)
   3758  1.8  christos 	{
   3759  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3760  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_struct;
   3761  1.8  christos 	  last_struct = ibfd;
   3762  1.8  christos 	}
   3763  1.8  christos       else if (out_struct < in_struct)
   3764  1.7  christos 	{
   3765  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3766  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3767  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3768  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
   3769  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3770  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3771  1.8  christos 	}
   3772  1.8  christos       else if (out_struct > in_struct)
   3773  1.8  christos 	{
   3774  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3775  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3776  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3777  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
   3778  1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3779  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3780  1.1  christos 	}
   3781  1.8  christos     }
   3782  1.1  christos   if (!ret)
   3783  1.1  christos     {
   3784  1.1  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3785  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   3786  1.1  christos     }
   3787  1.1  christos 
   3788  1.7  christos   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
   3789  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
   3790  1.7  christos }
   3791  1.1  christos 
   3792  1.1  christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
   3793  1.1  christos    object file when linking.  */
   3794  1.1  christos 
   3795  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   3796  1.1  christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3797  1.1  christos {
   3798  1.1  christos   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3799  1.7  christos   flagword old_flags;
   3800  1.1  christos   flagword new_flags;
   3801  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean error;
   3802  1.7  christos 
   3803  1.1  christos   if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
   3804  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   3805  1.1  christos 
   3806  1.1  christos   /* Check if we have the same endianness.  */
   3807  1.1  christos   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
   3808  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   3809  1.1  christos 
   3810  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3811  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   3812  1.1  christos 
   3813  1.1  christos   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   3814  1.1  christos   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
   3815  1.1  christos   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
   3816  1.1  christos     {
   3817  1.1  christos       /* First call, no flags set.  */
   3818  1.1  christos       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
   3819  1.1  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
   3820  1.1  christos     }
   3821  1.1  christos 
   3822  1.1  christos   /* Compatible flags are ok.  */
   3823  1.1  christos   else if (new_flags == old_flags)
   3824  1.1  christos     ;
   3825  1.1  christos 
   3826  1.1  christos   /* Incompatible flags.  */
   3827  1.1  christos   else
   3828  1.7  christos     {
   3829  1.8  christos       /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch.  Allow -mrelocatable-lib
   3830  1.1  christos 	 to be linked with either.  */
   3831  1.1  christos       error = FALSE;
   3832  1.1  christos       if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
   3833  1.1  christos 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
   3834  1.1  christos 	{
   3835  1.1  christos 	  error = TRUE;
   3836  1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3837  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
   3838  1.1  christos 	       "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
   3839  1.1  christos 	}
   3840  1.1  christos       else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
   3841  1.1  christos 	       && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
   3842  1.1  christos 	{
   3843  1.1  christos 	  error = TRUE;
   3844  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3845  1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
   3846  1.1  christos 	       "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
   3847  1.1  christos 	}
   3848  1.1  christos 
   3849  1.1  christos       /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are.  */
   3850  1.1  christos       if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
   3851  1.1  christos 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
   3852  1.1  christos 
   3853  1.1  christos       /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
   3854  1.1  christos 	 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib.  */
   3855  1.1  christos       if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
   3856  1.1  christos 	  && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
   3857  1.1  christos 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
   3858  1.1  christos 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
   3859  1.1  christos 
   3860  1.1  christos       /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
   3861  1.1  christos 	 any module uses it.  */
   3862  1.1  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
   3863  1.7  christos 
   3864  1.7  christos       new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3865  1.8  christos       old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3866  1.8  christos 
   3867  1.8  christos       /* Warn about any other mismatches.  */
   3868  1.1  christos       if (new_flags != old_flags)
   3869  1.1  christos 	{
   3870  1.1  christos 	  error = TRUE;
   3871  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3872  1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3873  1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
   3874  1.1  christos 	       "than previous modules (%#x)"),
   3875  1.1  christos 	     ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
   3876  1.1  christos 	}
   3877  1.1  christos 
   3878  1.1  christos       if (error)
   3879  1.1  christos 	{
   3880  1.1  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3881  1.7  christos 	  return FALSE;
   3882  1.7  christos 	}
   3883  1.7  christos     }
   3884  1.7  christos 
   3885  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   3886  1.7  christos }
   3887  1.7  christos 
   3888  1.1  christos static void
   3889  1.8  christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
   3890  1.1  christos 		     asection *input_section,
   3891  1.7  christos 		     unsigned long offset,
   3892  1.8  christos 		     bfd_byte *loc,
   3893  1.7  christos 		     bfd_vma value,
   3894  1.7  christos 		     split16_format_type split16_format,
   3895  1.7  christos 		     bfd_boolean fixup)
   3896  1.7  christos {
   3897  1.7  christos   unsigned int insn, opcode;
   3898  1.7  christos 
   3899  1.7  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
   3900  1.7  christos   opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
   3901  1.7  christos   if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
   3902  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
   3903  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
   3904  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
   3905  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
   3906  1.8  christos     {
   3907  1.7  christos       if (split16_format != split16a_type)
   3908  1.7  christos 	{
   3909  1.7  christos 	  if (fixup)
   3910  1.7  christos 	    split16_format = split16a_type;
   3911  1.7  christos 	  else
   3912  1.7  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3913  1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3914  1.7  christos 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3915  1.7  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3916  1.7  christos 	}
   3917  1.7  christos     }
   3918  1.7  christos   else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
   3919  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
   3920  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
   3921  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
   3922  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
   3923  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
   3924  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
   3925  1.8  christos     {
   3926  1.7  christos       if (split16_format != split16d_type)
   3927  1.7  christos 	{
   3928  1.7  christos 	  if (fixup)
   3929  1.8  christos 	    split16_format = split16d_type;
   3930  1.8  christos 	  else
   3931  1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3932  1.8  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3933  1.8  christos 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3934  1.8  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3935  1.8  christos 	}
   3936  1.8  christos     }
   3937  1.8  christos   if (split16_format == split16a_type)
   3938  1.8  christos     {
   3939  1.8  christos       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
   3940  1.8  christos       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3941  1.8  christos       if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
   3942  1.8  christos 	{
   3943  1.8  christos 	  /* Hack for e_li.  Extend sign.  */
   3944  1.8  christos 	  insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
   3945  1.3  christos 	  insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3946  1.7  christos 	}
   3947  1.1  christos     }
   3948  1.8  christos   else
   3949  1.8  christos     {
   3950  1.8  christos       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
   3951  1.8  christos       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
   3952  1.8  christos     }
   3953  1.8  christos   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3954  1.8  christos   bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
   3955  1.8  christos }
   3956  1.8  christos 
   3957  1.8  christos static void
   3958  1.8  christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
   3959  1.8  christos {
   3960  1.8  christos   unsigned int insn;
   3961  1.8  christos 
   3962  1.8  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   3963  1.8  christos   /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   3964  1.8  christos   /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   3965  1.1  christos   insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3966  1.1  christos   /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   3967  1.1  christos   insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3968  1.1  christos   /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   3969  1.1  christos   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3970  1.3  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
   3971  1.1  christos }
   3972  1.1  christos 
   3973  1.1  christos 
   3974  1.1  christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
   3976  1.1  christos    Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT.  */
   3977  1.1  christos int
   3978  1.1  christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   3979  1.1  christos 			   struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3980  1.1  christos {
   3981  1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   3982  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   3983  1.6  christos 
   3984  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   3985  1.1  christos 
   3986  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3987  1.1  christos     {
   3988  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   3989  1.1  christos 
   3990  1.1  christos       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
   3991  1.8  christos 	htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3992  1.1  christos       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3993  1.1  christos 	       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   3994  1.1  christos 	       && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
   3995  1.1  christos 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
   3996  1.1  christos 	       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
   3997  1.1  christos 		   || h->needs_plt)
   3998  1.1  christos 	       && h->ref_regular
   3999  1.1  christos 	       && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   4000  1.1  christos 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   4001  1.1  christos 	{
   4002  1.3  christos 	  /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
   4003  1.1  christos 	     secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
   4004  1.1  christos 	     function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
   4005  1.1  christos 	     r30 to be set up.  */
   4006  1.1  christos 	  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4007  1.1  christos 	}
   4008  1.1  christos       else
   4009  1.1  christos 	{
   4010  1.3  christos 	  bfd *ibfd;
   4011  1.1  christos 	  enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
   4012  1.1  christos 
   4013  1.1  christos 	  /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
   4014  1.1  christos 	     Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
   4015  1.1  christos 	     without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
   4016  1.1  christos 	     --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs.  */
   4017  1.1  christos 	  if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   4018  1.1  christos 	    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4019  1.1  christos 	  for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4020  1.1  christos 	    if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4021  1.1  christos 	      {
   4022  1.1  christos 		if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
   4023  1.1  christos 		  plt_type = PLT_NEW;
   4024  1.1  christos 		else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
   4025  1.3  christos 		  {
   4026  1.1  christos 		    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4027  1.1  christos 		    htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
   4028  1.8  christos 		    break;
   4029  1.1  christos 		  }
   4030  1.8  christos 	      }
   4031  1.1  christos 	  htab->plt_type = plt_type;
   4032  1.1  christos 	}
   4033  1.1  christos     }
   4034  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
   4035  1.1  christos     {
   4036  1.1  christos       if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
   4037  1.1  christos 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
   4038  1.1  christos       else
   4039  1.1  christos 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
   4040  1.1  christos     }
   4041  1.7  christos 
   4042  1.7  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
   4043  1.1  christos 
   4044  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   4045  1.1  christos     {
   4046  1.7  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   4047  1.7  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   4048  1.1  christos 
   4049  1.1  christos       /* The new PLT is a loaded section.  */
   4050  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4051  1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.splt, flags))
   4052  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4053  1.1  christos 
   4054  1.1  christos       /* The new GOT is not executable.  */
   4055  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   4056  1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   4057  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4058  1.1  christos     }
   4059  1.1  christos   else
   4060  1.1  christos     {
   4061  1.1  christos       /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment.  */
   4062  1.1  christos       if (htab->glink != NULL
   4063  1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink, 0))
   4064  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4065  1.1  christos     }
   4066  1.1  christos   return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
   4067  1.1  christos }
   4068  1.1  christos 
   4069  1.1  christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
   4071  1.1  christos    relocation.  */
   4072  1.1  christos 
   4073  1.1  christos static asection *
   4074  1.1  christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
   4075  1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4076  1.1  christos 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4077  1.1  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4078  1.1  christos 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   4079  1.1  christos {
   4080  1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   4081  1.1  christos     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   4082  1.8  christos       {
   4083  1.8  christos       case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   4084  1.8  christos       case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   4085  1.8  christos 	return NULL;
   4086  1.8  christos       }
   4087  1.8  christos 
   4088  1.8  christos   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
   4089  1.1  christos }
   4090  1.8  christos 
   4091  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   4092  1.8  christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
   4093  1.8  christos 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
   4094  1.8  christos 	   asection **symsecp,
   4095  1.8  christos 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
   4096  1.1  christos 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
   4097  1.8  christos 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
   4098  1.8  christos 	   bfd *ibfd)
   4099  1.8  christos {
   4100  1.8  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4101  1.1  christos 
   4102  1.8  christos   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4103  1.8  christos     {
   4104  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4105  1.8  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4106  1.8  christos 
   4107  1.1  christos       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4108  1.8  christos       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4109  1.8  christos 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4110  1.8  christos 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4111  1.8  christos 
   4112  1.8  christos       if (hp != NULL)
   4113  1.8  christos 	*hp = h;
   4114  1.8  christos 
   4115  1.8  christos       if (symp != NULL)
   4116  1.1  christos 	*symp = NULL;
   4117  1.8  christos 
   4118  1.8  christos       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4119  1.8  christos 	{
   4120  1.8  christos 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
   4121  1.1  christos 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4122  1.8  christos 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   4123  1.8  christos 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
   4124  1.1  christos 	  *symsecp = symsec;
   4125  1.8  christos 	}
   4126  1.1  christos 
   4127  1.8  christos       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4128  1.8  christos 	*tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4129  1.8  christos     }
   4130  1.8  christos   else
   4131  1.8  christos     {
   4132  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4133  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
   4134  1.8  christos 
   4135  1.8  christos       if (locsyms == NULL)
   4136  1.8  christos 	{
   4137  1.1  christos 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
   4138  1.8  christos 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4139  1.8  christos 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
   4140  1.8  christos 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
   4141  1.8  christos 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
   4142  1.8  christos 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4143  1.8  christos 	    return FALSE;
   4144  1.8  christos 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
   4145  1.8  christos 	}
   4146  1.1  christos       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
   4147  1.8  christos 
   4148  1.8  christos       if (hp != NULL)
   4149  1.8  christos 	*hp = NULL;
   4150  1.8  christos 
   4151  1.1  christos       if (symp != NULL)
   4152  1.8  christos 	*symp = sym;
   4153  1.8  christos 
   4154  1.8  christos       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4155  1.1  christos 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
   4156  1.8  christos 
   4157  1.8  christos       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4158  1.8  christos 	{
   4159  1.8  christos 	  bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   4160  1.8  christos 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4161  1.1  christos 
   4162  1.8  christos 	  tls_mask = NULL;
   4163  1.1  christos 	  local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4164  1.8  christos 	  if (local_got != NULL)
   4165  1.8  christos 	    {
   4166  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4167  1.8  christos 		(local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4168  1.8  christos 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4169  1.8  christos 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4170  1.8  christos 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4171  1.8  christos 	    }
   4172  1.8  christos 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
   4173  1.8  christos 	}
   4174  1.8  christos     }
   4175  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   4176  1.8  christos }
   4177  1.8  christos 
   4178  1.8  christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
   4180  1.8  christos    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
   4181  1.8  christos 
   4182  1.8  christos bfd_boolean
   4183  1.8  christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4184  1.8  christos {
   4185  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4186  1.8  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   4187  1.8  christos   asection *sec;
   4188  1.8  christos   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
   4189  1.8  christos 
   4190  1.8  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4191  1.8  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   4192  1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   4193  1.8  christos 
   4194  1.8  christos   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
   4195  1.8  christos      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
   4196  1.8  christos      between the call and its destination.  */
   4197  1.1  christos   limit = 0x1e00000;
   4198  1.8  christos   low_vma = -1;
   4199  1.8  christos   high_vma = 0;
   4200  1.8  christos   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4201  1.8  christos     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
   4202  1.8  christos       {
   4203  1.8  christos 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
   4204  1.8  christos 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
   4205  1.8  christos 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
   4206  1.8  christos 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
   4207  1.8  christos       }
   4208  1.8  christos 
   4209  1.8  christos   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
   4210  1.8  christos      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
   4211  1.8  christos      is local.  */
   4212  1.8  christos   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
   4213  1.8  christos     {
   4214  1.8  christos       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
   4215  1.8  christos       return TRUE;
   4216  1.8  christos     }
   4217  1.8  christos 
   4218  1.8  christos   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
   4219  1.8  christos      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
   4220  1.8  christos      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
   4221  1.8  christos      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
   4222  1.8  christos      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
   4223  1.8  christos      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
   4224  1.8  christos      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
   4225  1.8  christos      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
   4226  1.8  christos      particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
   4227  1.1  christos      call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
   4228  1.8  christos      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
   4229  1.8  christos      together except their symbol.  */
   4230  1.1  christos 
   4231  1.8  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4232  1.8  christos     {
   4233  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   4234  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
   4235  1.8  christos 
   4236  1.1  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4237  1.8  christos 	continue;
   4238  1.8  christos 
   4239  1.8  christos       local_syms = NULL;
   4240  1.8  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4241  1.8  christos 
   4242  1.1  christos       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4243  1.8  christos 	if (sec->has_pltcall
   4244  1.8  christos 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4245  1.8  christos 	  {
   4246  1.8  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4247  1.8  christos 
   4248  1.8  christos 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
   4249  1.8  christos 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4250  1.8  christos 						  info->keep_memory);
   4251  1.8  christos 	    if (relstart == NULL)
   4252  1.8  christos 	      return FALSE;
   4253  1.8  christos 
   4254  1.8  christos 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4255  1.8  christos 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
   4256  1.8  christos 	      {
   4257  1.8  christos 		enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4258  1.8  christos 		unsigned long r_symndx;
   4259  1.8  christos 		asection *sym_sec;
   4260  1.8  christos 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4261  1.8  christos 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4262  1.8  christos 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
   4263  1.8  christos 
   4264  1.8  christos 		r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4265  1.8  christos 		if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
   4266  1.8  christos 		  continue;
   4267  1.8  christos 
   4268  1.1  christos 		r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4269  1.8  christos 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
   4270  1.8  christos 				r_symndx, ibfd))
   4271  1.8  christos 		  {
   4272  1.8  christos 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4273  1.8  christos 		      free (relstart);
   4274  1.8  christos 		    if (local_syms != NULL
   4275  1.8  christos 			&& symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4276  1.8  christos 		      free (local_syms);
   4277  1.8  christos 		    return FALSE;
   4278  1.8  christos 		  }
   4279  1.8  christos 
   4280  1.8  christos 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   4281  1.8  christos 		  {
   4282  1.8  christos 		    bfd_vma from, to;
   4283  1.8  christos 		    if (h != NULL)
   4284  1.8  christos 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
   4285  1.8  christos 		    else
   4286  1.8  christos 		      to = sym->st_value;
   4287  1.8  christos 		    to += (rel->r_addend
   4288  1.8  christos 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
   4289  1.1  christos 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
   4290  1.8  christos 		    from = (rel->r_offset
   4291  1.8  christos 			    + sec->output_offset
   4292  1.8  christos 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
   4293  1.8  christos 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
   4294  1.8  christos 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
   4295  1.8  christos 		  }
   4296  1.8  christos 	      }
   4297  1.1  christos 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4298  1.1  christos 	      free (relstart);
   4299  1.8  christos 	  }
   4300  1.1  christos 
   4301  1.1  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   4302  1.8  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4303  1.1  christos 	{
   4304  1.1  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   4305  1.1  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   4306  1.1  christos 	  else
   4307  1.3  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   4308  1.1  christos 	}
   4309  1.1  christos     }
   4310  1.1  christos 
   4311  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   4312  1.1  christos }
   4313  1.1  christos 
   4314  1.5  christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
   4315  1.5  christos    generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
   4316  1.5  christos 
   4317  1.3  christos asection *
   4318  1.1  christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4319  1.1  christos {
   4320  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4321  1.1  christos 
   4322  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4323  1.1  christos   htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   4324  1.1  christos 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   4325  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   4326  1.1  christos     htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
   4327  1.1  christos 
   4328  1.1  christos   if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   4329  1.1  christos     {
   4330  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
   4331  1.1  christos       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
   4332  1.1  christos 				  FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   4333  1.1  christos       if (opt != NULL
   4334  1.1  christos 	  && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4335  1.1  christos 	      || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   4336  1.8  christos 	{
   4337  1.1  christos 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
   4338  1.1  christos 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
   4339  1.1  christos 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
   4340  1.1  christos 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   4341  1.1  christos 	  tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
   4342  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   4343  1.1  christos 	      && tga != NULL
   4344  1.1  christos 	      && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
   4345  1.1  christos 		  || tga->needs_plt)
   4346  1.1  christos 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
   4347  1.7  christos 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
   4348  1.1  christos 	    {
   4349  1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4350  1.1  christos 	      for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4351  1.1  christos 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4352  1.1  christos 		  break;
   4353  1.1  christos 	      if (ent != NULL)
   4354  1.1  christos 		{
   4355  1.1  christos 		  tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
   4356  1.1  christos 		  tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
   4357  1.1  christos 		  ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
   4358  1.1  christos 		  opt->mark = 1;
   4359  1.1  christos 		  if (opt->dynindx != -1)
   4360  1.1  christos 		    {
   4361  1.1  christos 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
   4362  1.3  christos 		      opt->dynindx = -1;
   4363  1.1  christos 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   4364  1.1  christos 					      opt->dynstr_index);
   4365  1.7  christos 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
   4366  1.7  christos 			return FALSE;
   4367  1.1  christos 		    }
   4368  1.7  christos 		  htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
   4369  1.7  christos 		}
   4370  1.1  christos 	    }
   4371  1.1  christos 	}
   4372  1.1  christos       else
   4373  1.1  christos 	htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
   4374  1.1  christos     }
   4375  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   4376  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4377  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
   4378  1.1  christos     {
   4379  1.1  christos       elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
   4380  1.1  christos       elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
   4381  1.1  christos     }
   4382  1.1  christos 
   4383  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
   4384  1.1  christos }
   4385  1.1  christos 
   4386  1.1  christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
   4387  1.1  christos    HASH.  */
   4388  1.1  christos 
   4389  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4390  1.1  christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
   4391  1.1  christos 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4392  1.1  christos 			 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
   4393  1.1  christos {
   4394  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4395  1.1  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4396  1.1  christos   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4397  1.1  christos 
   4398  1.1  christos   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4399  1.1  christos     {
   4400  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4401  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4402  1.1  christos 
   4403  1.1  christos       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4404  1.1  christos       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4405  1.1  christos 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4406  1.1  christos 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4407  1.1  christos       if (h == hash)
   4408  1.1  christos 	return TRUE;
   4409  1.1  christos     }
   4410  1.1  christos   return FALSE;
   4411  1.1  christos }
   4412  1.1  christos 
   4413  1.1  christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
   4414  1.6  christos    opportunities.  */
   4415  1.1  christos 
   4416  1.1  christos bfd_boolean
   4417  1.1  christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   4418  1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4419  1.1  christos {
   4420  1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   4421  1.1  christos   asection *sec;
   4422  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4423  1.1  christos   int pass;
   4424  1.1  christos 
   4425  1.1  christos   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   4426  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   4427  1.1  christos 
   4428  1.3  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4429  1.1  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   4430  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   4431  1.1  christos 
   4432  1.1  christos   /* Make two passes through the relocs.  First time check that tls
   4433  1.1  christos      relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
   4434  1.1  christos      followed by such a call.  If they are not, don't do any tls
   4435  1.1  christos      optimization.  On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
   4436  1.1  christos      notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
   4437  1.1  christos      adjust got and plt refcounts.  */
   4438  1.1  christos   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
   4439  1.1  christos     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4440  1.1  christos       {
   4441  1.1  christos 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4442  1.1  christos 	asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
   4443  1.1  christos 
   4444  1.1  christos 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4445  1.1  christos 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4446  1.1  christos 	    {
   4447  1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4448  1.1  christos 	      int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4449  1.1  christos 
   4450  1.1  christos 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
   4451  1.8  christos 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4452  1.8  christos 						    info->keep_memory);
   4453  1.1  christos 	      if (relstart == NULL)
   4454  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   4455  1.1  christos 
   4456  1.1  christos 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4457  1.1  christos 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
   4458  1.1  christos 		{
   4459  1.1  christos 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4460  1.1  christos 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
   4461  1.1  christos 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
   4462  1.1  christos 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4463  1.1  christos 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
   4464  1.1  christos 		  bfd_boolean is_local;
   4465  1.1  christos 		  bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
   4466  1.1  christos 
   4467  1.1  christos 		  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4468  1.1  christos 		  if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4469  1.1  christos 		    {
   4470  1.1  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4471  1.1  christos 
   4472  1.1  christos 		      sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4473  1.1  christos 		      h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4474  1.1  christos 		      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4475  1.1  christos 			     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4476  1.1  christos 			h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4477  1.1  christos 		    }
   4478  1.1  christos 
   4479  1.1  christos 		  is_local = FALSE;
   4480  1.1  christos 		  if (h == NULL
   4481  1.1  christos 		      || !h->def_dynamic)
   4482  1.1  christos 		    is_local = TRUE;
   4483  1.1  christos 
   4484  1.1  christos 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4485  1.1  christos 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4486  1.1  christos 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
   4487  1.1  christos 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
   4488  1.1  christos 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
   4489  1.1  christos 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
   4490  1.1  christos 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
   4491  1.1  christos 		  if (pass == 0
   4492  1.1  christos 		      && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
   4493  1.1  christos 		      && h != NULL
   4494  1.1  christos 		      && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   4495  1.1  christos 		      && !expecting_tls_get_addr
   4496  1.1  christos 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4497  1.1  christos 		    {
   4498  1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
   4499  1.1  christos 					      "TLS optimization disabled\n",
   4500  1.1  christos 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4501  1.7  christos 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4502  1.1  christos 			free (relstart);
   4503  1.1  christos 		      return TRUE;
   4504  1.1  christos 		    }
   4505  1.1  christos 
   4506  1.1  christos 		  expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4507  1.1  christos 		  switch (r_type)
   4508  1.1  christos 		    {
   4509  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   4510  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   4511  1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4512  1.1  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4513  1.1  christos 
   4514  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   4515  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   4516  1.1  christos 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
   4517  1.1  christos 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
   4518  1.1  christos 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
   4519  1.7  christos 		      if (!is_local)
   4520  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4521  1.1  christos 
   4522  1.1  christos 		      /* LD -> LE */
   4523  1.1  christos 		      tls_set = 0;
   4524  1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
   4525  1.1  christos 		      break;
   4526  1.1  christos 
   4527  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   4528  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   4529  1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4530  1.1  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4531  1.1  christos 
   4532  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   4533  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   4534  1.1  christos 		      if (is_local)
   4535  1.1  christos 			/* GD -> LE */
   4536  1.1  christos 			tls_set = 0;
   4537  1.1  christos 		      else
   4538  1.1  christos 			/* GD -> IE */
   4539  1.1  christos 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPRELGD;
   4540  1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
   4541  1.1  christos 		      break;
   4542  1.1  christos 
   4543  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   4544  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   4545  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   4546  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   4547  1.1  christos 		      if (is_local)
   4548  1.8  christos 			{
   4549  1.8  christos 			  /* IE -> LE */
   4550  1.8  christos 			  tls_set = 0;
   4551  1.8  christos 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
   4552  1.8  christos 			  break;
   4553  1.8  christos 			}
   4554  1.8  christos 		      else
   4555  1.8  christos 			continue;
   4556  1.8  christos 
   4557  1.8  christos 		    case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   4558  1.8  christos 		    case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   4559  1.8  christos 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4560  1.8  christos 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   4561  1.8  christos 			{
   4562  1.8  christos 			  if (pass != 0
   4563  1.8  christos 			      && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
   4564  1.8  christos 			    {
   4565  1.8  christos 			      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
   4566  1.8  christos 			      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
   4567  1.8  christos 			      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4568  1.8  christos 				{
   4569  1.8  christos 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4570  1.8  christos 
   4571  1.8  christos 				  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4572  1.8  christos 				  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4573  1.8  christos 				  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4574  1.8  christos 					 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4575  1.8  christos 				    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4576  1.8  christos 				  if (h != NULL)
   4577  1.8  christos 				    {
   4578  1.8  christos 				      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
   4579  1.8  christos 				      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4580  1.8  christos 
   4581  1.8  christos 				      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4582  1.1  christos 					addend = rel->r_addend;
   4583  1.1  christos 				      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
   4584  1.1  christos 							  got2, addend);
   4585  1.1  christos 				      if (ent != NULL
   4586  1.1  christos 					  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4587  1.1  christos 					ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4588  1.1  christos 				    }
   4589  1.1  christos 				}
   4590  1.1  christos 			    }
   4591  1.1  christos 			  continue;
   4592  1.1  christos 			}
   4593  1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
   4594  1.8  christos 		      tls_set = 0;
   4595  1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = 0;
   4596  1.1  christos 		      break;
   4597  1.1  christos 
   4598  1.1  christos 		    default:
   4599  1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4600  1.1  christos 		    }
   4601  1.1  christos 
   4602  1.1  christos 		  if (pass == 0)
   4603  1.1  christos 		    {
   4604  1.1  christos 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
   4605  1.1  christos 			  || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
   4606  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4607  1.1  christos 
   4608  1.1  christos 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4609  1.1  christos 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
   4610  1.1  christos 						      htab->tls_get_addr))
   4611  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4612  1.1  christos 
   4613  1.1  christos 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
   4614  1.1  christos 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
   4615  1.1  christos 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
   4616  1.1  christos 			 the entire optimization.  */
   4617  1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
   4618  1.1  christos 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
   4619  1.1  christos 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4620  1.1  christos 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4621  1.1  christos 			free (relstart);
   4622  1.1  christos 		      return TRUE;
   4623  1.8  christos 		    }
   4624  1.1  christos 
   4625  1.1  christos 		  if (h != NULL)
   4626  1.1  christos 		    {
   4627  1.1  christos 		      tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4628  1.1  christos 		      got_count = &h->got.refcount;
   4629  1.1  christos 		    }
   4630  1.8  christos 		  else
   4631  1.8  christos 		    {
   4632  1.1  christos 		      bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
   4633  1.1  christos 		      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   4634  1.1  christos 		      unsigned char *lgot_masks;
   4635  1.1  christos 
   4636  1.8  christos 		      lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4637  1.8  christos 		      if (lgot_refs == NULL)
   4638  1.8  christos 			abort ();
   4639  1.8  christos 		      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4640  1.8  christos 			(lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4641  1.8  christos 		      lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4642  1.8  christos 			(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4643  1.8  christos 		      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4644  1.8  christos 		      got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
   4645  1.8  christos 		    }
   4646  1.8  christos 
   4647  1.8  christos 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4648  1.8  christos 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
   4649  1.8  christos 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
   4650  1.8  christos 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
   4651  1.8  christos 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
   4652  1.8  christos 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
   4653  1.8  christos 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
   4654  1.8  christos 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
   4655  1.8  christos 		      && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
   4656  1.8  christos 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   4657  1.8  christos 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
   4658  1.8  christos 		    continue;
   4659  1.8  christos 
   4660  1.8  christos 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
   4661  1.8  christos 		    {
   4662  1.8  christos 		      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4663  1.8  christos 		      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4664  1.8  christos 
   4665  1.8  christos 		      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   4666  1.8  christos 			  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   4667  1.1  christos 			      || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
   4668  1.1  christos 			addend = rel[1].r_addend;
   4669  1.1  christos 		      ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
   4670  1.1  christos 					  got2, addend);
   4671  1.1  christos 		      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4672  1.1  christos 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4673  1.1  christos 
   4674  1.1  christos 		      if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
   4675  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4676  1.1  christos 		    }
   4677  1.1  christos 
   4678  1.1  christos 		  if (tls_set == 0)
   4679  1.1  christos 		    {
   4680  1.1  christos 		      /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
   4681  1.1  christos 		      if (*got_count > 0)
   4682  1.8  christos 			*got_count -= 1;
   4683  1.1  christos 		    }
   4684  1.1  christos 
   4685  1.1  christos 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
   4686  1.8  christos 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
   4687  1.1  christos 		}
   4688  1.8  christos 
   4689  1.1  christos 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4690  1.1  christos 		free (relstart);
   4691  1.1  christos 	    }
   4692  1.1  christos       }
   4693  1.1  christos   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
   4694  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   4695  1.1  christos }
   4696  1.1  christos 
   4697  1.8  christos /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections.  */
   4699  1.8  christos 
   4700  1.8  christos static asection *
   4701  1.8  christos readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4702  1.8  christos {
   4703  1.8  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   4704  1.8  christos 
   4705  1.8  christos   for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   4706  1.8  christos     {
   4707  1.8  christos       asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
   4708  1.8  christos 
   4709  1.8  christos       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4710  1.8  christos 	return p->sec;
   4711  1.8  christos     }
   4712  1.8  christos   return NULL;
   4713  1.8  christos }
   4714  1.1  christos 
   4715  1.8  christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
   4716  1.8  christos    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
   4717  1.8  christos    size_dynamic_sections.  */
   4718  1.8  christos 
   4719  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   4720  1.8  christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4721  1.8  christos {
   4722  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
   4723  1.8  christos   do
   4724  1.8  christos     {
   4725  1.8  christos       if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
   4726  1.8  christos 	return TRUE;
   4727  1.8  christos       eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
   4728  1.8  christos     } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
   4729  1.8  christos 
   4730  1.8  christos   return FALSE;
   4731  1.1  christos }
   4732  1.1  christos 
   4733  1.1  christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
   4734  1.1  christos 
   4735  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4736  1.1  christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4737  1.1  christos {
   4738  1.1  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   4739  1.1  christos 
   4740  1.1  christos   for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   4741  1.1  christos     if (p->pc_count != 0)
   4742  1.1  christos       return TRUE;
   4743  1.1  christos   return FALSE;
   4744  1.1  christos }
   4745  1.1  christos 
   4746  1.1  christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
   4747  1.1  christos    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
   4748  1.1  christos    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
   4749  1.1  christos    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
   4750  1.1  christos    understand.  */
   4751  1.1  christos 
   4752  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4753  1.1  christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4754  1.1  christos 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4755  1.1  christos {
   4756  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4757  1.8  christos   asection *s;
   4758  1.1  christos 
   4759  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   4760  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
   4761  1.1  christos 	   h->root.root.string);
   4762  1.1  christos #endif
   4763  1.1  christos 
   4764  1.1  christos   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
   4765  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4766  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
   4767  1.8  christos 	      && (h->needs_plt
   4768  1.8  christos 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4769  1.8  christos 		  || h->is_weakalias
   4770  1.8  christos 		  || (h->def_dynamic
   4771  1.8  christos 		      && h->ref_regular
   4772  1.8  christos 		      && !h->def_regular)));
   4773  1.8  christos 
   4774  1.1  christos   /* Deal with function syms.  */
   4775  1.1  christos   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
   4776  1.1  christos       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4777  1.1  christos       || h->needs_plt)
   4778  1.1  christos     {
   4779  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   4780  1.1  christos 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
   4781  1.1  christos       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
   4782  1.8  christos 	 function symbol is local.  */
   4783  1.8  christos       if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
   4784  1.8  christos 	ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4785  1.8  christos 
   4786  1.1  christos       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
   4787  1.1  christos 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
   4788  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   4789  1.1  christos       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4790  1.1  christos 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4791  1.1  christos 	  break;
   4792  1.1  christos       if (ent == NULL
   4793  1.1  christos 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4794  1.1  christos 	      && local
   4795  1.1  christos 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   4796  1.1  christos 		  || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   4797  1.1  christos 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
   4798  1.1  christos 	{
   4799  1.3  christos 	  /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
   4800  1.1  christos 
   4801  1.1  christos 	     1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
   4802  1.1  christos 	     can't be set up, so we can't use one.  In this case,
   4803  1.3  christos 	     ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
   4804  1.3  christos 
   4805  1.3  christos 	     2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
   4806  1.7  christos 
   4807  1.7  christos 	     3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
   4808  1.7  christos 	     will go to this object, or will remain undefined.  */
   4809  1.7  christos 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4810  1.7  christos 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   4811  1.7  christos 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4812  1.7  christos 	}
   4813  1.8  christos       else
   4814  1.8  christos 	{
   4815  1.8  christos 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
   4816  1.3  christos 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
   4817  1.3  christos 	     executable on a plt call stub.  A dynamic reloc can
   4818  1.3  christos 	     be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
   4819  1.3  christos 	     (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
   4820  1.3  christos 	     through the plt call stub.)  Similarly, use a dynamic
   4821  1.8  christos 	     reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
   4822  1.8  christos 	     resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
   4823  1.8  christos 	     than link time.  */
   4824  1.8  christos 	  if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
   4825  1.8  christos 	       || (h->non_got_ref
   4826  1.8  christos 		   && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
   4827  1.8  christos 		   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   4828  1.8  christos 	      && !htab->is_vxworks
   4829  1.8  christos 	      && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4830  1.1  christos 	      && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4831  1.5  christos 	    {
   4832  1.8  christos 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4833  1.1  christos 	      /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
   4834  1.1  christos 		 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
   4835  1.1  christos 	      if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   4836  1.1  christos 		h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4837  1.1  christos 	    }
   4838  1.1  christos 	  else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   4839  1.1  christos 	    /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
   4840  1.1  christos 	       plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
   4841  1.8  christos 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4842  1.1  christos 	}
   4843  1.8  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4844  1.8  christos       /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
   4845  1.8  christos       return TRUE;
   4846  1.8  christos     }
   4847  1.8  christos   else
   4848  1.8  christos     h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4849  1.8  christos 
   4850  1.8  christos   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
   4851  1.1  christos      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
   4852  1.1  christos      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
   4853  1.1  christos   if (h->is_weakalias)
   4854  1.1  christos     {
   4855  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
   4856  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
   4857  1.1  christos       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
   4858  1.1  christos       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
   4859  1.1  christos       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
   4860  1.1  christos 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   4861  1.6  christos 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
   4862  1.5  christos 	ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4863  1.5  christos       return TRUE;
   4864  1.5  christos     }
   4865  1.5  christos 
   4866  1.1  christos   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
   4867  1.1  christos      is not a function.  */
   4868  1.1  christos 
   4869  1.1  christos   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
   4870  1.5  christos      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
   4871  1.5  christos      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
   4872  1.5  christos      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
   4873  1.5  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4874  1.5  christos     {
   4875  1.5  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4876  1.5  christos       return TRUE;
   4877  1.5  christos     }
   4878  1.5  christos 
   4879  1.5  christos   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
   4880  1.5  christos      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
   4881  1.5  christos   if (!h->non_got_ref)
   4882  1.5  christos     {
   4883  1.5  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4884  1.5  christos       return TRUE;
   4885  1.5  christos     }
   4886  1.5  christos 
   4887  1.5  christos   /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
   4888  1.5  christos      .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
   4889  1.5  christos      definition for the variable.  Editing to PIC, or text relocations
   4890  1.5  christos      are preferable to an incorrect program.  */
   4891  1.5  christos   if (h->protected_def)
   4892  1.8  christos     {
   4893  1.1  christos       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4894  1.8  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   4895  1.1  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   4896  1.1  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
   4897  1.1  christos 	  && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
   4898  1.1  christos 	htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
   4899  1.1  christos       return TRUE;
   4900  1.1  christos     }
   4901  1.1  christos 
   4902  1.1  christos   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
   4903  1.1  christos   if (info->nocopyreloc)
   4904  1.8  christos     return TRUE;
   4905  1.8  christos 
   4906  1.1  christos    /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
   4907  1.1  christos       we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
   4908  1.1  christos       We can't do this if there are any small data relocations.  This
   4909  1.1  christos       doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
   4910  1.1  christos       relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
   4911  1.1  christos       executable.  */
   4912  1.1  christos   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4913  1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4914  1.1  christos       && !htab->is_vxworks
   4915  1.1  christos       && !h->def_regular
   4916  1.1  christos       && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4917  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   4918  1.1  christos 
   4919  1.1  christos   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
   4920  1.1  christos      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
   4921  1.7  christos      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
   4922  1.7  christos      object will contain position independent code, so all references
   4923  1.1  christos      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
   4924  1.7  christos      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
   4925  1.1  christos      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
   4926  1.1  christos      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
   4927  1.1  christos      same memory location for the variable.
   4928  1.1  christos 
   4929  1.1  christos      Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
   4930  1.1  christos      must instead allocate it in .sbss.  */
   4931  1.8  christos   if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4932  1.8  christos     s = htab->dynsbss;
   4933  1.8  christos   else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4934  1.1  christos     s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
   4935  1.1  christos   else
   4936  1.7  christos     s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
   4937  1.7  christos   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   4938  1.1  christos 
   4939  1.7  christos   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
   4940  1.1  christos     {
   4941  1.1  christos       asection *srel;
   4942  1.1  christos 
   4943  1.1  christos       /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
   4944  1.1  christos 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
   4945  1.8  christos 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
   4946  1.8  christos       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4947  1.3  christos 	srel = htab->relsbss;
   4948  1.1  christos       else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4949  1.1  christos 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   4950  1.1  christos       else
   4951  1.1  christos 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
   4952  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
   4953  1.1  christos       srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   4954  1.1  christos       h->needs_copy = 1;
   4955  1.1  christos     }
   4956  1.1  christos 
   4957  1.1  christos   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
   4958  1.1  christos   ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4959  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
   4960  1.1  christos }
   4961  1.1  christos 
   4962  1.1  christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs.  For non-PIC code the sym is
   4964  1.1  christos    xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
   4965  1.1  christos    specifying the addend on the plt relocation.  For -fpic code, the sym
   4966  1.1  christos    is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
   4967  1.6  christos    xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>.  */
   4968  1.1  christos 
   4969  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4970  1.1  christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
   4971  1.1  christos 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4972  1.1  christos 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4973  1.1  christos {
   4974  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   4975  1.1  christos   size_t len1, len2, len3;
   4976  1.1  christos   char *name;
   4977  1.1  christos   const char *stub;
   4978  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4979  1.1  christos 
   4980  1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4981  1.1  christos     stub = ".plt_pic32.";
   4982  1.1  christos   else
   4983  1.1  christos     stub = ".plt_call32.";
   4984  1.1  christos 
   4985  1.1  christos   len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
   4986  1.1  christos   len2 = strlen (stub);
   4987  1.1  christos   len3 = 0;
   4988  1.1  christos   if (ent->sec)
   4989  1.1  christos     len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
   4990  1.1  christos   name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
   4991  1.1  christos   if (name == NULL)
   4992  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   4993  1.1  christos   sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
   4994  1.1  christos   if (ent->sec)
   4995  1.1  christos     memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
   4996  1.1  christos   memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
   4997  1.1  christos   memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
   4998  1.5  christos   sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
   4999  1.1  christos   if (sh == NULL)
   5000  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   5001  1.1  christos   if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5002  1.1  christos     {
   5003  1.1  christos       sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5004  1.1  christos       sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5005  1.1  christos       sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
   5006  1.1  christos       sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5007  1.1  christos       sh->def_regular = 1;
   5008  1.1  christos       sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5009  1.1  christos       sh->forced_local = 1;
   5010  1.1  christos       sh->non_elf = 0;
   5011  1.1  christos       sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5012  1.1  christos     }
   5013  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5014  1.7  christos }
   5015  1.7  christos 
   5016  1.1  christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
   5017  1.1  christos    Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k.  */
   5018  1.1  christos 
   5019  1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   5020  1.1  christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
   5021  1.1  christos {
   5022  1.1  christos   bfd_vma where;
   5023  1.1  christos   unsigned int max_before_header;
   5024  1.1  christos 
   5025  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5026  1.1  christos     {
   5027  1.7  christos       where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5028  1.7  christos       htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5029  1.1  christos     }
   5030  1.7  christos   else
   5031  1.7  christos     {
   5032  1.1  christos       max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
   5033  1.7  christos       if (need <= htab->got_gap)
   5034  1.7  christos 	{
   5035  1.1  christos 	  where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
   5036  1.1  christos 	  htab->got_gap -= need;
   5037  1.1  christos 	}
   5038  1.1  christos       else
   5039  1.1  christos 	{
   5040  1.8  christos 	  if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
   5041  1.8  christos 	      && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
   5042  1.8  christos 	    {
   5043  1.8  christos 	      htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5044  1.8  christos 	      htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
   5045  1.8  christos 	    }
   5046  1.8  christos 	  where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5047  1.8  christos 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5048  1.8  christos 	}
   5049  1.8  christos     }
   5050  1.8  christos   return where;
   5051  1.8  christos }
   5052  1.8  christos 
   5053  1.8  christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
   5054  1.8  christos    TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot.  */
   5055  1.8  christos 
   5056  1.8  christos static inline unsigned int
   5057  1.8  christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
   5058  1.8  christos {
   5059  1.8  christos   unsigned int need;
   5060  1.8  christos   if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
   5061  1.8  christos     need = 4;
   5062  1.8  christos   else
   5063  1.8  christos     {
   5064  1.8  christos       need = 0;
   5065  1.8  christos       if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   5066  1.8  christos 	need += 8;
   5067  1.8  christos       if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
   5068  1.8  christos 	need += 4;
   5069  1.8  christos       if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   5070  1.8  christos 	need += 4;
   5071  1.8  christos     }
   5072  1.8  christos   return need;
   5073  1.8  christos }
   5074  1.8  christos 
   5075  1.8  christos /* Calculate size of relocs needed for symbol given its TLS_MASK and
   5076  1.8  christos    NEEDed GOT entries.  KNOWN says a TPREL offset can be calculated at
   5077  1.8  christos    link time.  */
   5078  1.8  christos 
   5079  1.8  christos static inline unsigned int
   5080  1.8  christos got_relocs_needed (int tls_mask, unsigned int need, bfd_boolean known)
   5081  1.7  christos {
   5082  1.7  christos   /* All the entries we allocated need relocs.
   5083  1.8  christos      Except IE in executable with a local symbol.  We could also omit
   5084  1.8  christos      the DTPREL reloc on the second word of a GD entry under the same
   5085  1.7  christos      condition as that for IE, but ld.so needs to differentiate
   5086  1.7  christos      LD and GD entries.  */
   5087  1.7  christos   if (known && (tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5088  1.7  christos       && (tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
   5089  1.8  christos     need -= 4;
   5090  1.8  christos   return need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5091  1.8  christos }
   5092  1.7  christos 
   5093  1.7  christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
   5094  1.7  christos 
   5095  1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   5096  1.7  christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   5097  1.7  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5098  1.7  christos {
   5099  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
   5100  1.1  christos 
   5101  1.1  christos   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
   5102  1.1  christos       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
   5103  1.1  christos 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   5104  1.1  christos 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   5105  1.1  christos       && h->dynindx == -1
   5106  1.1  christos       && !h->forced_local
   5107  1.1  christos       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
   5108  1.7  christos     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
   5109  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5110  1.1  christos }
   5111  1.1  christos 
   5112  1.1  christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs.  */
   5113  1.1  christos 
   5114  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   5115  1.5  christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   5116  1.5  christos {
   5117  1.5  christos   struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
   5118  1.5  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   5119  1.5  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5120  1.5  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   5121  1.5  christos   bfd_boolean dyn;
   5122  1.1  christos 
   5123  1.1  christos   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   5124  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   5125  1.8  christos 
   5126  1.8  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5127  1.7  christos   eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   5128  1.1  christos   if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
   5129  1.1  christos       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   5130  1.8  christos 	  && !eh->elf.def_regular
   5131  1.1  christos 	  && eh->elf.protected_def
   5132  1.8  christos 	  && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5133  1.8  christos 	  && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5134  1.8  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5135  1.8  christos     {
   5136  1.8  christos       unsigned int need;
   5137  1.8  christos 
   5138  1.1  christos       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5139  1.1  christos       if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
   5140  1.8  christos 	return FALSE;
   5141  1.1  christos 
   5142  1.1  christos       need = 0;
   5143  1.1  christos       if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5144  1.1  christos 	{
   5145  1.1  christos 	  if (!eh->elf.def_dynamic)
   5146  1.6  christos 	    /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset.  This should
   5147  1.7  christos 	       always be the case.  It's a little odd if we have
   5148  1.7  christos 	       a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol.  */
   5149  1.7  christos 	    htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5150  1.8  christos 	  else
   5151  1.1  christos 	    need += 8;
   5152  1.8  christos 	}
   5153  1.8  christos       need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
   5154  1.8  christos       if (need == 0)
   5155  1.8  christos 	eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5156  1.1  christos       else
   5157  1.8  christos 	{
   5158  1.8  christos 	  eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5159  1.8  christos 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
   5160  1.8  christos 	       || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5161  1.8  christos 		   && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
   5162  1.1  christos 		   && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
   5163  1.7  christos 	      && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
   5164  1.8  christos 	    {
   5165  1.1  christos 	      asection *rsec;
   5166  1.1  christos 	      bfd_boolean tprel_known = (bfd_link_executable (info)
   5167  1.1  christos 					 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
   5168  1.1  christos 								     &eh->elf));
   5169  1.1  christos 
   5170  1.1  christos 	      need = got_relocs_needed (eh->tls_mask, need, tprel_known);
   5171  1.8  christos 	      if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
   5172  1.8  christos 		  && eh->elf.def_dynamic)
   5173  1.7  christos 		need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5174  1.7  christos 	      rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5175  1.7  christos 	      if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5176  1.7  christos 		rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5177  1.8  christos 	      rsec->size += need;
   5178  1.8  christos 	    }
   5179  1.8  christos 	}
   5180  1.8  christos     }
   5181  1.8  christos   else
   5182  1.8  christos     eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5183  1.8  christos 
   5184  1.8  christos   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
   5185  1.8  christos      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
   5186  1.8  christos   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5187  1.7  christos       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5188  1.7  christos     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5189  1.1  christos 
   5190  1.1  christos   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
   5191  1.1  christos   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   5192  1.1  christos 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
   5193  1.1  christos     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5194  1.1  christos 
   5195  1.7  christos   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
   5196  1.1  christos      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
   5197  1.1  christos   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   5198  1.1  christos     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5199  1.1  christos 
   5200  1.1  christos   if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
   5201  1.1  christos     ;
   5202  1.1  christos 
   5203  1.1  christos   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
   5204  1.1  christos      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
   5205  1.1  christos      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
   5206  1.1  christos      space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
   5207  1.1  christos      changes.  */
   5208  1.1  christos   else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5209  1.1  christos     {
   5210  1.1  christos       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
   5211  1.1  christos 	 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
   5212  1.1  christos 	 generated via assembly.  We want calls to protected symbols to
   5213  1.1  christos 	 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
   5214  1.1  christos 	 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
   5215  1.1  christos 	 then they should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
   5216  1.1  christos       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
   5217  1.1  christos 	{
   5218  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5219  1.1  christos 
   5220  1.1  christos 	  for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5221  1.1  christos 	    {
   5222  1.1  christos 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
   5223  1.1  christos 	      p->pc_count = 0;
   5224  1.1  christos 	      if (p->count == 0)
   5225  1.1  christos 		*pp = p->next;
   5226  1.1  christos 	      else
   5227  1.1  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   5228  1.1  christos 	    }
   5229  1.1  christos 	}
   5230  1.1  christos 
   5231  1.8  christos       if (htab->is_vxworks)
   5232  1.1  christos 	{
   5233  1.8  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5234  1.8  christos 
   5235  1.7  christos 	  for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5236  1.1  christos 	    {
   5237  1.1  christos 	      if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5238  1.1  christos 		*pp = p->next;
   5239  1.1  christos 	      else
   5240  1.7  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   5241  1.1  christos 	    }
   5242  1.1  christos 	}
   5243  1.8  christos 
   5244  1.5  christos       if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   5245  1.8  christos 	{
   5246  1.5  christos 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5247  1.5  christos 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5248  1.5  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5249  1.5  christos 	}
   5250  1.1  christos     }
   5251  1.8  christos   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
   5252  1.8  christos     {
   5253  1.7  christos       /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
   5254  1.1  christos 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
   5255  1.7  christos 	 dynamic.  */
   5256  1.7  christos       if (h->dynamic_adjusted
   5257  1.1  christos 	  && !h->def_regular
   5258  1.7  christos 	  && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
   5259  1.7  christos 	  && !(h->protected_def
   5260  1.1  christos 	       && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5261  1.1  christos 	       && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5262  1.7  christos 	       && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5263  1.1  christos 	{
   5264  1.1  christos 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5265  1.1  christos 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5266  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5267  1.7  christos 
   5268  1.1  christos 	  if (h->dynindx == -1)
   5269  1.1  christos 	    eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5270  1.1  christos 	}
   5271  1.8  christos       else
   5272  1.8  christos 	eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5273  1.8  christos     }
   5274  1.8  christos 
   5275  1.8  christos   /* Allocate space.  */
   5276  1.8  christos   for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   5277  1.7  christos     {
   5278  1.8  christos       asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5279  1.8  christos       if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5280  1.8  christos 	sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5281  1.8  christos       sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5282  1.8  christos     }
   5283  1.8  christos 
   5284  1.8  christos   /* Handle PLT relocs.  Done last, after dynindx has settled.
   5285  1.8  christos      We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
   5286  1.8  christos      a) is dynamic, or
   5287  1.7  christos      b) is an ifunc, or
   5288  1.7  christos      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
   5289  1.7  christos      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
   5290  1.8  christos   dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
   5291  1.7  christos   if (dyn
   5292  1.7  christos       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   5293  1.7  christos       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
   5294  1.7  christos       || (h->needs_plt
   5295  1.7  christos 	  && h->def_regular
   5296  1.7  christos 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5297  1.7  christos 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5298  1.8  christos 	  && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   5299  1.8  christos 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
   5300  1.8  christos     {
   5301  1.8  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   5302  1.8  christos       bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
   5303  1.8  christos       bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5304  1.7  christos 
   5305  1.7  christos       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5306  1.7  christos 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5307  1.7  christos 	  {
   5308  1.7  christos 	    asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
   5309  1.7  christos 
   5310  1.7  christos 	    if (!dyn)
   5311  1.7  christos 	      {
   5312  1.7  christos 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5313  1.7  christos 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5314  1.8  christos 		else
   5315  1.8  christos 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5316  1.8  christos 	      }
   5317  1.7  christos 
   5318  1.8  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   5319  1.8  christos 	      {
   5320  1.8  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5321  1.8  christos 		  {
   5322  1.8  christos 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5323  1.8  christos 		    s->size += 4;
   5324  1.8  christos 		  }
   5325  1.8  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5326  1.8  christos 
   5327  1.8  christos 		if (s == htab->pltlocal)
   5328  1.8  christos 		  ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5329  1.8  christos 		else
   5330  1.8  christos 		  {
   5331  1.8  christos 		    s = htab->glink;
   5332  1.8  christos 		    if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
   5333  1.8  christos 		      {
   5334  1.8  christos 			glink_offset = s->size;
   5335  1.8  christos 			s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   5336  1.8  christos 		      }
   5337  1.7  christos 		    if (!doneone
   5338  1.7  christos 			&& !bfd_link_pic (info)
   5339  1.7  christos 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5340  1.7  christos 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5341  1.7  christos 		      {
   5342  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5343  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
   5344  1.7  christos 		      }
   5345  1.7  christos 		    ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5346  1.7  christos 
   5347  1.7  christos 		    if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
   5348  1.7  christos 			&& !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
   5349  1.7  christos 		      return FALSE;
   5350  1.7  christos 		  }
   5351  1.7  christos 	      }
   5352  1.7  christos 	    else
   5353  1.7  christos 	      {
   5354  1.7  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5355  1.7  christos 		  {
   5356  1.7  christos 		    /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
   5357  1.7  christos 		       for the special first entry.  */
   5358  1.7  christos 		    if (s->size == 0)
   5359  1.7  christos 		      s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
   5360  1.7  christos 
   5361  1.7  christos 		    /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
   5362  1.7  christos 		       parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
   5363  1.7  christos 		       and a jump), and then there is a remaining
   5364  1.7  christos 		       word available at the end.  */
   5365  1.7  christos 		    plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
   5366  1.7  christos 				  + (htab->plt_slot_size
   5367  1.7  christos 				     * ((s->size
   5368  1.7  christos 					 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5369  1.7  christos 					/ htab->plt_entry_size)));
   5370  1.7  christos 
   5371  1.7  christos 		    /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
   5372  1.7  christos 		       file, and we are not generating a shared
   5373  1.7  christos 		       library, then set the symbol to this location
   5374  1.7  christos 		       in the .plt.  This is to avoid text
   5375  1.7  christos 		       relocations, and is required to make
   5376  1.7  christos 		       function pointers compare as equal between
   5377  1.7  christos 		       the normal executable and the shared library.  */
   5378  1.7  christos 		    if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
   5379  1.7  christos 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5380  1.7  christos 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5381  1.7  christos 		      {
   5382  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5383  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
   5384  1.7  christos 		      }
   5385  1.7  christos 
   5386  1.7  christos 		    /* Make room for this entry.  */
   5387  1.7  christos 		    s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5388  1.7  christos 		    /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
   5389  1.7  christos 		       is allocated.  */
   5390  1.8  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
   5391  1.8  christos 			&& (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5392  1.8  christos 			/ htab->plt_entry_size
   5393  1.8  christos 			> PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
   5394  1.8  christos 		      s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5395  1.8  christos 		  }
   5396  1.8  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5397  1.8  christos 	      }
   5398  1.8  christos 
   5399  1.8  christos 	    /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   5400  1.8  christos 	    if (!doneone)
   5401  1.8  christos 	      {
   5402  1.7  christos 		if (!dyn)
   5403  1.7  christos 		  {
   5404  1.7  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5405  1.7  christos 		      {
   5406  1.7  christos 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5407  1.7  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5408  1.7  christos 		      }
   5409  1.7  christos 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5410  1.7  christos 		      {
   5411  1.7  christos 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5412  1.7  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5413  1.7  christos 		      }
   5414  1.7  christos 		  }
   5415  1.7  christos 		else
   5416  1.7  christos 		  {
   5417  1.7  christos 		    htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5418  1.7  christos 
   5419  1.7  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5420  1.7  christos 		      {
   5421  1.7  christos 			/* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations.  */
   5422  1.7  christos 			if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   5423  1.7  christos 			    && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5424  1.7  christos 			  {
   5425  1.7  christos 			    if (ent->plt.offset
   5426  1.7  christos 				== (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5427  1.7  christos 			      {
   5428  1.7  christos 				htab->srelplt2->size
   5429  1.7  christos 				  += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5430  1.7  christos 				      * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
   5431  1.7  christos 			      }
   5432  1.7  christos 
   5433  1.7  christos 			    htab->srelplt2->size
   5434  1.7  christos 			      += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5435  1.7  christos 				  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
   5436  1.7  christos 			  }
   5437  1.7  christos 
   5438  1.7  christos 			/* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
   5439  1.7  christos 			   .got.plt.  */
   5440  1.7  christos 			htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
   5441  1.7  christos 		      }
   5442  1.7  christos 		  }
   5443  1.7  christos 		doneone = TRUE;
   5444  1.7  christos 	      }
   5445  1.7  christos 	  }
   5446  1.7  christos 	else
   5447  1.7  christos 	  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5448  1.1  christos 
   5449  1.1  christos       if (!doneone)
   5450  1.1  christos 	{
   5451  1.1  christos 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5452  1.1  christos 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   5453  1.1  christos 	}
   5454  1.1  christos     }
   5455  1.8  christos   else
   5456  1.1  christos     {
   5457  1.8  christos       h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5458  1.8  christos       h->needs_plt = 0;
   5459  1.1  christos     }
   5460  1.1  christos 
   5461  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5462  1.8  christos }
   5463  1.8  christos 
   5464  1.1  christos /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
   5465  1.8  christos    read-only sections.  */
   5466  1.8  christos 
   5467  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   5468  1.8  christos maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
   5469  1.8  christos {
   5470  1.8  christos   asection *sec;
   5471  1.1  christos 
   5472  1.1  christos   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   5473  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   5474  1.1  christos 
   5475  1.1  christos   sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
   5476  1.1  christos   if (sec != NULL)
   5477  1.1  christos     {
   5478  1.1  christos       struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
   5479  1.1  christos 
   5480  1.1  christos       info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
   5481  1.1  christos       info->callbacks->minfo
   5482  1.1  christos 	(_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
   5483  1.1  christos 	 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
   5484  1.1  christos 
   5485  1.1  christos       /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal.  */
   5486  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   5487  1.1  christos     }
   5488  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5489  1.1  christos }
   5490  1.1  christos 
   5491  1.1  christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
   5492  1.1  christos {
   5493  1.1  christos   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
   5494  1.1  christos   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
   5495  1.3  christos   1,					/* CIE version.  */
   5496  1.1  christos   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
   5497  1.1  christos   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
   5498  1.1  christos   0x7c,					/* Data alignment.  */
   5499  1.1  christos   65,					/* RA reg.  */
   5500  1.1  christos   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
   5501  1.1  christos   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
   5502  1.1  christos   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
   5503  1.1  christos };
   5504  1.1  christos 
   5505  1.1  christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
   5506  1.1  christos 
   5507  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   5508  1.1  christos ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   5509  1.1  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info)
   5510  1.1  christos {
   5511  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5512  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   5513  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean relocs;
   5514  1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   5515  1.1  christos 
   5516  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   5517  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
   5518  1.1  christos #endif
   5519  1.1  christos 
   5520  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5521  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
   5522  1.1  christos 
   5523  1.1  christos   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
   5524  1.1  christos     {
   5525  1.1  christos       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
   5526  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
   5527  1.1  christos 	{
   5528  1.1  christos 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
   5529  1.3  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   5530  1.1  christos 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5531  1.1  christos 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5532  1.1  christos 	}
   5533  1.1  christos     }
   5534  1.1  christos 
   5535  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5536  1.1  christos     htab->got_header_size = 16;
   5537  1.1  christos   else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   5538  1.1  christos     htab->got_header_size = 12;
   5539  1.1  christos 
   5540  1.1  christos   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
   5541  1.1  christos      relocs.  */
   5542  1.1  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   5543  1.1  christos     {
   5544  1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   5545  1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
   5546  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   5547  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
   5548  1.1  christos       char *lgot_masks;
   5549  1.1  christos       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   5550  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   5551  1.1  christos 
   5552  1.1  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   5553  1.1  christos 	continue;
   5554  1.1  christos 
   5555  1.1  christos       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5556  1.1  christos 	{
   5557  1.1  christos 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   5558  1.1  christos 
   5559  1.1  christos 	  for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
   5560  1.1  christos 		    elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
   5561  1.1  christos 	       p != NULL;
   5562  1.1  christos 	       p = p->next)
   5563  1.1  christos 	    {
   5564  1.1  christos 	      if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
   5565  1.1  christos 		  && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
   5566  1.1  christos 		{
   5567  1.1  christos 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
   5568  1.1  christos 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
   5569  1.1  christos 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
   5570  1.7  christos 		     the relocs too.  */
   5571  1.1  christos 		}
   5572  1.1  christos 	      else if (htab->is_vxworks
   5573  1.1  christos 		       && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
   5574  1.1  christos 				  ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5575  1.8  christos 		{
   5576  1.8  christos 		  /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
   5577  1.8  christos 		     handled specially by the loader.  */
   5578  1.8  christos 		}
   5579  1.8  christos 	      else if (p->count != 0)
   5580  1.1  christos 		{
   5581  1.1  christos 		  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5582  1.1  christos 		  if (p->ifunc)
   5583  1.1  christos 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5584  1.1  christos 		  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5585  1.1  christos 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
   5586  1.1  christos 		       & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5587  1.1  christos 		      == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5588  1.1  christos 		    {
   5589  1.1  christos 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
   5590  1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
   5591  1.1  christos 					      p->sec->owner, p->sec);
   5592  1.1  christos 		    }
   5593  1.1  christos 		}
   5594  1.1  christos 	    }
   5595  1.1  christos 	}
   5596  1.1  christos 
   5597  1.1  christos       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   5598  1.8  christos       if (!local_got)
   5599  1.8  christos 	continue;
   5600  1.8  christos 
   5601  1.8  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   5602  1.1  christos       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   5603  1.1  christos       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   5604  1.1  christos       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   5605  1.1  christos       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   5606  1.1  christos       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5607  1.6  christos 
   5608  1.1  christos       for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
   5609  1.8  christos 	if (*local_got > 0)
   5610  1.8  christos 	  {
   5611  1.8  christos 	    unsigned int need;
   5612  1.8  christos 	    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5613  1.8  christos 	      htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5614  1.8  christos 	    need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
   5615  1.7  christos 	    if (need == 0)
   5616  1.8  christos 	      *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5617  1.1  christos 	    else
   5618  1.1  christos 	      {
   5619  1.1  christos 		*local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5620  1.1  christos 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5621  1.1  christos 		  {
   5622  1.1  christos 		    asection *srel;
   5623  1.1  christos 		    bfd_boolean tprel_known = bfd_link_executable (info);
   5624  1.1  christos 
   5625  1.1  christos 		    need = got_relocs_needed (*lgot_masks, need, tprel_known);
   5626  1.1  christos 		    srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5627  1.8  christos 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5628  1.8  christos 		      srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5629  1.1  christos 		    srel->size += need;
   5630  1.1  christos 		  }
   5631  1.1  christos 	      }
   5632  1.8  christos 	  }
   5633  1.1  christos 	else
   5634  1.1  christos 	  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5635  1.1  christos 
   5636  1.1  christos       if (htab->is_vxworks)
   5637  1.8  christos 	continue;
   5638  1.8  christos 
   5639  1.8  christos       /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt.  */
   5640  1.8  christos       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5641  1.8  christos       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
   5642  1.8  christos 	{
   5643  1.8  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   5644  1.8  christos 	  bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
   5645  1.8  christos 	  bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5646  1.8  christos 
   5647  1.1  christos 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5648  1.1  christos 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5649  1.1  christos 	      {
   5650  1.1  christos 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5651  1.1  christos 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5652  1.1  christos 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5653  1.1  christos 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
   5654  1.1  christos 		  {
   5655  1.8  christos 		    ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5656  1.1  christos 		    continue;
   5657  1.8  christos 		  }
   5658  1.1  christos 		else
   5659  1.8  christos 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5660  1.1  christos 
   5661  1.1  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5662  1.1  christos 		  {
   5663  1.1  christos 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5664  1.1  christos 		    s->size += 4;
   5665  1.8  christos 		  }
   5666  1.8  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5667  1.8  christos 
   5668  1.8  christos 		if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
   5669  1.8  christos 		  {
   5670  1.8  christos 		    s = htab->glink;
   5671  1.8  christos 		    glink_offset = s->size;
   5672  1.8  christos 		    s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
   5673  1.8  christos 		  }
   5674  1.8  christos 		ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5675  1.1  christos 
   5676  1.1  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5677  1.1  christos 		  {
   5678  1.1  christos 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5679  1.1  christos 		      {
   5680  1.1  christos 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5681  1.1  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5682  1.1  christos 		      }
   5683  1.1  christos 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5684  1.1  christos 		      {
   5685  1.1  christos 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5686  1.1  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5687  1.1  christos 		      }
   5688  1.1  christos 		    doneone = TRUE;
   5689  1.6  christos 		  }
   5690  1.7  christos 	      }
   5691  1.1  christos 	    else
   5692  1.1  christos 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5693  1.1  christos 	}
   5694  1.1  christos     }
   5695  1.7  christos 
   5696  1.1  christos   /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs.  */
   5697  1.1  christos   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
   5698  1.1  christos 
   5699  1.1  christos   if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
   5700  1.1  christos     {
   5701  1.1  christos       htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
   5702  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5703  1.7  christos 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5704  1.1  christos     }
   5705  1.7  christos   else
   5706  1.1  christos     htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5707  1.1  christos 
   5708  1.7  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
   5709  1.1  christos     {
   5710  1.1  christos       unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
   5711  1.1  christos 
   5712  1.1  christos       /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now.  When we get here,
   5713  1.6  christos 	 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
   5714  1.1  christos 	 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated).  For new plt/got, the
   5715  1.1  christos 	 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536.  */
   5716  1.3  christos       if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
   5717  1.3  christos 	{
   5718  1.3  christos 	  g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5719  1.3  christos 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5720  1.3  christos 	    g_o_t += 4;
   5721  1.3  christos 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
   5722  1.3  christos 	}
   5723  1.3  christos 
   5724  1.3  christos       htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
   5725  1.3  christos     }
   5726  1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5727  1.3  christos     {
   5728  1.3  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5729  1.1  christos 
   5730  1.1  christos       sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
   5731  1.1  christos       sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   5732  1.1  christos     }
   5733  1.1  christos   if (info->emitrelocations)
   5734  1.1  christos     {
   5735  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5736  1.8  christos 
   5737  1.8  christos       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5738  1.8  christos 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5739  1.1  christos       sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   5740  1.3  christos       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5741  1.3  christos 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5742  1.1  christos     }
   5743  1.1  christos 
   5744  1.3  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5745  1.1  christos       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5746  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5747  1.1  christos     {
   5748  1.1  christos       htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
   5749  1.1  christos       /* Space for the branch table.  */
   5750  1.1  christos       htab->glink->size
   5751  1.1  christos 	+= htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
   5752  1.1  christos       /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve.  */
   5753  1.1  christos       htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   5754  1.1  christos 						 ? 63 : 15);
   5755  1.1  christos       htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5756  1.1  christos 
   5757  1.1  christos       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
   5758  1.1  christos 	{
   5759  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   5760  1.1  christos 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
   5761  1.5  christos 				     TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
   5762  1.1  christos 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5763  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5764  1.1  christos 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5765  1.1  christos 	    {
   5766  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5767  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5768  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
   5769  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5770  1.1  christos 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5771  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5772  1.1  christos 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5773  1.1  christos 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5774  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5775  1.1  christos 	    }
   5776  1.1  christos 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
   5777  1.5  christos 				     TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
   5778  1.1  christos 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5779  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5780  1.1  christos 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5781  1.1  christos 	    {
   5782  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5783  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5784  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5785  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5786  1.1  christos 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5787  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5788  1.1  christos 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5789  1.1  christos 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5790  1.6  christos 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5791  1.1  christos 	    }
   5792  1.1  christos 	}
   5793  1.1  christos     }
   5794  1.1  christos 
   5795  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5796  1.1  christos       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5797  1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5798  1.1  christos       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
   5799  1.1  christos       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
   5800  1.1  christos     {
   5801  1.1  christos       s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
   5802  1.1  christos       s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
   5803  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5804  1.1  christos 	{
   5805  1.1  christos 	  s->size += 4;
   5806  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
   5807  1.1  christos 	    s->size += 4;
   5808  1.7  christos 	}
   5809  1.7  christos     }
   5810  1.1  christos 
   5811  1.1  christos   /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
   5812  1.1  christos      Allocate memory for them.  */
   5813  1.1  christos   relocs = FALSE;
   5814  1.1  christos   for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5815  1.1  christos     {
   5816  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
   5817  1.1  christos 
   5818  1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
   5819  1.7  christos 	continue;
   5820  1.8  christos 
   5821  1.1  christos       if (s == htab->elf.splt
   5822  1.1  christos 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot)
   5823  1.7  christos 	{
   5824  1.1  christos 	  /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
   5825  1.7  christos 	     we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
   5826  1.7  christos 	     It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols.  */
   5827  1.3  christos 	  if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
   5828  1.3  christos 	    strip_section = FALSE;
   5829  1.3  christos 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
   5830  1.3  christos 	     comment below.  */
   5831  1.3  christos 	}
   5832  1.1  christos       else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
   5833  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
   5834  1.3  christos 	       || s == htab->glink
   5835  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
   5836  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
   5837  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->sbss
   5838  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
   5839  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   5840  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->dynsbss)
   5841  1.1  christos 	{
   5842  1.1  christos 	  /* Strip these too.  */
   5843  1.1  christos 	}
   5844  1.1  christos       else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
   5845  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
   5846  1.1  christos 	{
   5847  1.1  christos 	  strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
   5848  1.1  christos 	}
   5849  1.1  christos       else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (htab->elf.dynobj, s),
   5850  1.1  christos 			     ".rela"))
   5851  1.1  christos 	{
   5852  1.1  christos 	  if (s->size != 0)
   5853  1.1  christos 	    {
   5854  1.1  christos 	      /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections.  */
   5855  1.1  christos 	      relocs = TRUE;
   5856  1.1  christos 
   5857  1.1  christos 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
   5858  1.1  christos 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
   5859  1.1  christos 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
   5860  1.1  christos 	    }
   5861  1.1  christos 	}
   5862  1.1  christos       else
   5863  1.1  christos 	{
   5864  1.1  christos 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
   5865  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   5866  1.1  christos 	}
   5867  1.1  christos 
   5868  1.1  christos       if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
   5869  1.1  christos 	{
   5870  1.1  christos 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
   5871  1.1  christos 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
   5872  1.1  christos 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
   5873  1.1  christos 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
   5874  1.1  christos 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
   5875  1.1  christos 	     sections.  The linker does that before
   5876  1.1  christos 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
   5877  1.1  christos 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
   5878  1.1  christos 	     into these sections.  */
   5879  1.1  christos 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   5880  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   5881  1.1  christos 	}
   5882  1.1  christos 
   5883  1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   5884  1.1  christos 	continue;
   5885  1.1  christos 
   5886  1.1  christos       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
   5887  1.1  christos       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
   5888  1.1  christos       if (s->contents == NULL)
   5889  1.6  christos 	return FALSE;
   5890  1.1  christos     }
   5891  1.1  christos 
   5892  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5893  1.1  christos     {
   5894  1.1  christos       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
   5895  1.7  christos 	 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
   5896  1.1  christos 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
   5897  1.1  christos 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
   5898  1.1  christos 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
   5899  1.1  christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
   5900  1.1  christos   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
   5901  1.1  christos 
   5902  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_executable (info))
   5903  1.1  christos 	{
   5904  1.3  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
   5905  1.3  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5906  1.3  christos 	}
   5907  1.1  christos 
   5908  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
   5909  1.1  christos 	{
   5910  1.3  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
   5911  1.1  christos 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
   5912  1.1  christos 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
   5913  1.1  christos 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
   5914  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5915  1.1  christos 	}
   5916  1.1  christos 
   5917  1.1  christos       if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   5918  1.1  christos 	  && htab->glink != NULL
   5919  1.1  christos 	  && htab->glink->size != 0)
   5920  1.1  christos 	{
   5921  1.1  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
   5922  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5923  1.1  christos 	  if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
   5924  1.1  christos 	      && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
   5925  1.1  christos 	      && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
   5926  1.1  christos 	      && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
   5927  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5928  1.1  christos 	}
   5929  1.1  christos 
   5930  1.1  christos       if (relocs)
   5931  1.1  christos 	{
   5932  1.1  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
   5933  1.1  christos 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
   5934  1.1  christos 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
   5935  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5936  1.1  christos 	}
   5937  1.1  christos 
   5938  1.1  christos       /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
   5939  1.1  christos 	 need a DT_TEXTREL entry.  */
   5940  1.1  christos       if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
   5941  1.1  christos 	elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
   5942  1.1  christos 				info);
   5943  1.1  christos 
   5944  1.1  christos       if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
   5945  1.1  christos 	{
   5946  1.1  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
   5947  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5948  1.1  christos 	}
   5949  1.1  christos       if (htab->is_vxworks
   5950  1.1  christos 	  && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
   5951  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   5952  1.1  christos    }
   5953  1.1  christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
   5954  1.1  christos 
   5955  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5956  1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   5957  1.1  christos     {
   5958  1.1  christos       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5959  1.1  christos       bfd_vma val;
   5960  1.1  christos 
   5961  1.1  christos       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
   5962  1.1  christos       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
   5963  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
   5964  1.1  christos       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5965  1.1  christos       /* FDE length.  */
   5966  1.1  christos       val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5967  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5968  1.6  christos       p += 4;
   5969  1.1  christos       /* CIE pointer.  */
   5970  1.1  christos       val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5971  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5972  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5973  1.1  christos       /* Offset to .glink.  Set later.  */
   5974  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5975  1.1  christos       /* .glink size.  */
   5976  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
   5977  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5978  1.1  christos       /* Augmentation.  */
   5979  1.1  christos       p += 1;
   5980  1.1  christos 
   5981  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5982  1.1  christos 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5983  1.1  christos 	{
   5984  1.1  christos 	  bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
   5985  1.1  christos 	  if (adv < 64)
   5986  1.1  christos 	    *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
   5987  1.1  christos 	  else if (adv < 256)
   5988  1.1  christos 	    {
   5989  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
   5990  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = adv;
   5991  1.1  christos 	    }
   5992  1.1  christos 	  else if (adv < 65536)
   5993  1.1  christos 	    {
   5994  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
   5995  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5996  1.1  christos 	      p += 2;
   5997  1.1  christos 	    }
   5998  1.1  christos 	  else
   5999  1.1  christos 	    {
   6000  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
   6001  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   6002  1.1  christos 	      p += 4;
   6003  1.1  christos 	    }
   6004  1.1  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
   6005  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = 65;
   6006  1.3  christos 	  p++;
   6007  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
   6008  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
   6009  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = 65;
   6010  1.3  christos 	}
   6011  1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
   6012  1.3  christos 		  == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
   6013  1.3  christos     }
   6014  1.3  christos 
   6015  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   6016  1.3  christos }
   6017  1.3  christos 
   6018  1.3  christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
   6019  1.3  christos    if it looks like nothing is using them.  */
   6020  1.3  christos 
   6021  1.3  christos static void
   6022  1.3  christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   6023  1.3  christos {
   6024  1.3  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
   6025  1.3  christos 
   6026  1.3  christos   if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
   6027  1.3  christos     {
   6028  1.3  christos       asection *s;
   6029  1.3  christos 
   6030  1.3  christos       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
   6031  1.3  christos       if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   6032  1.3  christos 	{
   6033  1.3  christos 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
   6034  1.3  christos 	  if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   6035  1.3  christos 	    {
   6036  1.3  christos 	      sda->def_regular = 0;
   6037  1.3  christos 	      /* This is somewhat magic.  See elf_link_output_extsym.  */
   6038  1.3  christos 	      sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
   6039  1.3  christos 	      sda->forced_local = 0;
   6040  1.3  christos 	    }
   6041  1.3  christos 	}
   6042  1.3  christos     }
   6043  1.3  christos }
   6044  1.3  christos 
   6045  1.1  christos void
   6046  1.1  christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6047  1.1  christos {
   6048  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6049  1.1  christos 
   6050  1.1  christos   if (htab != NULL)
   6051  1.1  christos     {
   6052  1.1  christos       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
   6053  1.1  christos       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
   6054  1.1  christos     }
   6055  1.1  christos }
   6056  1.1  christos 
   6057  1.1  christos 
   6058  1.1  christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
   6059  1.1  christos 
   6060  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6061  1.1  christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6062  1.1  christos {
   6063  1.1  christos   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
   6064  1.1  christos       && !h->def_regular
   6065  1.1  christos       && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
   6066  1.1  christos 	  || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
   6067  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   6068  1.1  christos 
   6069  1.3  christos   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
   6070  1.1  christos }
   6071  1.1  christos 
   6072  1.1  christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
   6074  1.1  christos 
   6075  1.1  christos /* Relaxation trampolines.  r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
   6076  1.1  christos    used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI).  */
   6077  1.1  christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
   6078  1.1  christos   {
   6079  1.1  christos     0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
   6080  1.1  christos     0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
   6081  1.1  christos     0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
   6082  1.1  christos     0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
   6083  1.3  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
   6084  1.3  christos     0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
   6085  1.3  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6086  1.5  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6087  1.3  christos   };
   6088  1.3  christos 
   6089  1.3  christos static const int stub_entry[] =
   6090  1.3  christos   {
   6091  1.3  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
   6092  1.3  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
   6093  1.3  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6094  1.1  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6095  1.1  christos   };
   6096  1.1  christos 
   6097  1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
   6098  1.1  christos {
   6099  1.1  christos   unsigned int workaround_size;
   6100  1.5  christos   unsigned int picfixup_size;
   6101  1.1  christos };
   6102  1.5  christos 
   6103  1.1  christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
   6104  1.1  christos    icache bug workaround.  Any section needing trampolines or patch
   6105  1.1  christos    space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
   6106  1.1  christos    add trampolines at the end of the section.  */
   6107  1.1  christos 
   6108  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6109  1.1  christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
   6110  1.1  christos 		       asection *isec,
   6111  1.1  christos 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
   6112  1.1  christos 		       bfd_boolean *again)
   6113  1.1  christos {
   6114  1.3  christos   struct one_branch_fixup
   6115  1.5  christos   {
   6116  1.3  christos     struct one_branch_fixup *next;
   6117  1.1  christos     asection *tsec;
   6118  1.3  christos     /* Final link, can use the symbol offset.  For a
   6119  1.1  christos        relocatable link we use the symbol's index.  */
   6120  1.5  christos     bfd_vma toff;
   6121  1.1  christos     bfd_vma trampoff;
   6122  1.1  christos   };
   6123  1.1  christos 
   6124  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   6125  1.1  christos   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   6126  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
   6127  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
   6128  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
   6129  1.3  christos   struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
   6130  1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   6131  1.1  christos   unsigned changes = 0;
   6132  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean workaround_change;
   6133  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   6134  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
   6135  1.1  christos   asection *got2;
   6136  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
   6137  1.3  christos 
   6138  1.3  christos   *again = FALSE;
   6139  1.3  christos 
   6140  1.3  christos   /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections.  */
   6141  1.3  christos   if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   6142  1.3  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
   6143  1.3  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
   6144  1.3  christos       || isec->size < 4)
   6145  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6146  1.3  christos 
   6147  1.3  christos   /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
   6148  1.3  christos      do anything.  The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
   6149  1.3  christos      anyway.  */
   6150  1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6151  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6152  1.5  christos 
   6153  1.5  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
   6154  1.3  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   6155  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6156  1.3  christos 
   6157  1.3  christos   isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
   6158  1.3  christos   if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   6159  1.3  christos     isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   6160  1.3  christos   trampbase = isec->size;
   6161  1.3  christos 
   6162  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
   6163  1.3  christos 	      || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
   6164  1.3  christos   isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
   6165  1.1  christos 
   6166  1.1  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6167  1.1  christos       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6168  1.1  christos     {
   6169  1.3  christos       if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6170  1.3  christos 	{
   6171  1.1  christos 	  elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
   6172  1.1  christos 	    = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
   6173  1.1  christos 	  if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6174  1.5  christos 	    return FALSE;
   6175  1.5  christos 	}
   6176  1.5  christos       relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
   6177  1.1  christos       trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
   6178  1.3  christos     }
   6179  1.3  christos 
   6180  1.1  christos   maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   6181  1.3  christos 		  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
   6182  1.3  christos   /* Space for a branch around any trampolines.  */
   6183  1.3  christos   trampoff = trampbase;
   6184  1.3  christos   if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
   6185  1.3  christos     trampoff += 4;
   6186  1.1  christos 
   6187  1.3  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   6188  1.1  christos   picfixup_size = 0;
   6189  1.3  christos   if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
   6190  1.3  christos       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6191  1.3  christos     {
   6192  1.3  christos       /* Get a copy of the native relocations.  */
   6193  1.3  christos       if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
   6194  1.3  christos 	{
   6195  1.5  christos 	  internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
   6196  1.3  christos 						       link_info->keep_memory);
   6197  1.5  christos 	  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
   6198  1.3  christos 	    goto error_return;
   6199  1.3  christos 	}
   6200  1.3  christos 
   6201  1.8  christos       got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   6202  1.3  christos 
   6203  1.3  christos       irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
   6204  1.3  christos       for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
   6205  1.3  christos 	{
   6206  1.3  christos 	  unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
   6207  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma toff, roff;
   6208  1.3  christos 	  asection *tsec;
   6209  1.3  christos 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f;
   6210  1.8  christos 	  size_t insn_offset = 0;
   6211  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
   6212  1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte *hit_addr;
   6213  1.1  christos 	  unsigned long t0;
   6214  1.3  christos 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   6215  1.3  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   6216  1.3  christos 	  struct plt_entry **plist;
   6217  1.3  christos 	  unsigned char sym_type;
   6218  1.3  christos 
   6219  1.1  christos 	  switch (r_type)
   6220  1.5  christos 	    {
   6221  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6222  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6223  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6224  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   6225  1.3  christos 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
   6226  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6227  1.1  christos 
   6228  1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6229  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6230  1.8  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6231  1.8  christos 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
   6232  1.8  christos 	      break;
   6233  1.8  christos 
   6234  1.8  christos 	    case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   6235  1.3  christos 	      if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6236  1.8  christos 		break;
   6237  1.8  christos 	      continue;
   6238  1.3  christos 
   6239  1.3  christos 	    default:
   6240  1.3  christos 	      continue;
   6241  1.8  christos 	    }
   6242  1.1  christos 
   6243  1.3  christos 	  /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
   6244  1.3  christos 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
   6245  1.1  christos 			  ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
   6246  1.3  christos 	    goto error_return;
   6247  1.1  christos 
   6248  1.8  christos 	  if (isym != NULL)
   6249  1.8  christos 	    {
   6250  1.3  christos 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6251  1.3  christos 		;
   6252  1.1  christos 	      else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
   6253  1.8  christos 		tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
   6254  1.8  christos 	      else
   6255  1.8  christos 		continue;
   6256  1.3  christos 
   6257  1.6  christos 	      toff = isym->st_value;
   6258  1.1  christos 	      sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
   6259  1.1  christos 	    }
   6260  1.3  christos 	  else
   6261  1.3  christos 	    {
   6262  1.3  christos 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6263  1.3  christos 		toff = h->root.u.def.value;
   6264  1.3  christos 	      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   6265  1.6  christos 		       || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   6266  1.3  christos 		{
   6267  1.3  christos 		  unsigned long indx;
   6268  1.1  christos 
   6269  1.3  christos 		  indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   6270  1.3  christos 		  tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
   6271  1.3  christos 		  toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
   6272  1.3  christos 		}
   6273  1.3  christos 	      else
   6274  1.3  christos 		continue;
   6275  1.3  christos 
   6276  1.3  christos 	      /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
   6277  1.3  christos 		 optimise away the call.  We won't be needing a long-
   6278  1.3  christos 		 branch stub in that case.  */
   6279  1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
   6280  1.3  christos 		  && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6281  1.3  christos 		  && irel != internal_relocs)
   6282  1.3  christos 		{
   6283  1.3  christos 		  unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
   6284  1.3  christos 		  unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
   6285  1.3  christos 		  unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
   6286  1.3  christos 
   6287  1.3  christos 		  /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
   6288  1.3  christos 		     R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
   6289  1.3  christos 		     on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn.  Get tls
   6290  1.3  christos 		     mask bits from the symbol on that reloc.  */
   6291  1.3  christos 		  if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   6292  1.3  christos 		    {
   6293  1.3  christos 		      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6294  1.1  christos 
   6295  1.3  christos 		      if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   6296  1.3  christos 			{
   6297  1.3  christos 			  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6298  1.1  christos 			    (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6299  1.3  christos 			  char *lgot_masks = (char *)
   6300  1.3  christos 			    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6301  1.3  christos 			  tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
   6302  1.1  christos 			}
   6303  1.3  christos 		    }
   6304  1.3  christos 		  else
   6305  1.3  christos 		    {
   6306  1.3  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
   6307  1.3  christos 			= elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   6308  1.3  christos 
   6309  1.3  christos 		      while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   6310  1.3  christos 			     || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   6311  1.3  christos 			th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
   6312  1.3  christos 
   6313  1.3  christos 		      tls_mask
   6314  1.3  christos 			= ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
   6315  1.3  christos 		    }
   6316  1.1  christos 
   6317  1.3  christos 		  /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
   6318  1.3  christos 		     optimised away.  */
   6319  1.1  christos 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   6320  1.5  christos 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
   6321  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
   6322  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
   6323  1.5  christos 		    continue;
   6324  1.5  christos 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   6325  1.5  christos 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
   6326  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
   6327  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
   6328  1.5  christos 		    continue;
   6329  1.5  christos 		}
   6330  1.5  christos 
   6331  1.3  christos 	      sym_type = h->type;
   6332  1.3  christos 	    }
   6333  1.3  christos 
   6334  1.3  christos 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   6335  1.3  christos 	    {
   6336  1.3  christos 	      if (h != NULL
   6337  1.3  christos 		  && !h->def_regular
   6338  1.3  christos 		  && h->protected_def
   6339  1.3  christos 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   6340  1.3  christos 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
   6341  1.3  christos 		picfixup_size += 12;
   6342  1.3  christos 	      continue;
   6343  1.3  christos 	    }
   6344  1.3  christos 
   6345  1.3  christos 	  /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
   6346  1.3  christos 	     match that in relocate_section.  If we call find_plt_ent here
   6347  1.3  christos 	     but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
   6348  1.3  christos 	     destination used here may be incorrect.  */
   6349  1.3  christos 	  plist = NULL;
   6350  1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   6351  1.3  christos 	    {
   6352  1.3  christos 	      /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true.  */
   6353  1.3  christos 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6354  1.3  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6355  1.1  christos 		plist = &h->plt.plist;
   6356  1.6  christos 	    }
   6357  1.3  christos 	  else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6358  1.3  christos 		   && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
   6359  1.3  christos 	    {
   6360  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6361  1.3  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6362  1.3  christos 		(local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6363  1.3  christos 	      plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
   6364  1.3  christos 	    }
   6365  1.3  christos 	  if (plist != NULL)
   6366  1.3  christos 	    {
   6367  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   6368  1.3  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   6369  1.3  christos 
   6370  1.3  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6371  1.7  christos 		addend = irel->r_addend;
   6372  1.3  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
   6373  1.3  christos 	      if (ent != NULL)
   6374  1.3  christos 		{
   6375  1.3  christos 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   6376  1.1  christos 		      || h == NULL
   6377  1.3  christos 		      || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   6378  1.3  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
   6379  1.3  christos 		    {
   6380  1.3  christos 		      tsec = htab->glink;
   6381  1.1  christos 		      toff = ent->glink_offset;
   6382  1.1  christos 		    }
   6383  1.8  christos 		  else
   6384  1.8  christos 		    {
   6385  1.8  christos 		      tsec = htab->elf.splt;
   6386  1.8  christos 		      toff = ent->plt.offset;
   6387  1.8  christos 		    }
   6388  1.8  christos 		}
   6389  1.8  christos 	    }
   6390  1.8  christos 
   6391  1.8  christos 	  /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
   6392  1.8  christos 	     no hope of adding stubs.  We'll error out later should the
   6393  1.8  christos 	     branch overflow.  */
   6394  1.3  christos 	  if (tsec == isec)
   6395  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6396  1.3  christos 
   6397  1.3  christos 	  /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
   6398  1.3  christos 	     undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
   6399  1.3  christos 	     support addends.  It would be possible to do so by
   6400  1.3  christos 	     putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
   6401  1.3  christos 	     branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting.  */
   6402  1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6403  1.3  christos 	      && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
   6404  1.3  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6405  1.3  christos 	      && irel->r_addend != 0)
   6406  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6407  1.3  christos 
   6408  1.3  christos 	  /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
   6409  1.3  christos 	     SEC_MERGE sections;  SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
   6410  1.3  christos 	     attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
   6411  1.3  christos 	     branches.  However, implement it correctly here as a
   6412  1.3  christos 	     reference for other target relax_section functions.  */
   6413  1.3  christos 	  if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   6414  1.3  christos 	    {
   6415  1.3  christos 	      /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
   6416  1.3  christos 		 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
   6417  1.8  christos 		 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
   6418  1.8  christos 		 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
   6419  1.3  christos 		 section symbols have been adjusted.)
   6420  1.3  christos 
   6421  1.3  christos 		 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
   6422  1.3  christos 		 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
   6423  1.3  christos 		 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
   6424  1.3  christos 		 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
   6425  1.1  christos 		 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
   6426  1.8  christos 		 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
   6427  1.8  christos 		 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
   6428  1.3  christos 		 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
   6429  1.3  christos 		 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
   6430  1.3  christos 		 location of interest is just "sym".  */
   6431  1.3  christos 	      if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
   6432  1.3  christos 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6433  1.1  christos 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6434  1.3  christos 
   6435  1.6  christos 	      toff
   6436  1.3  christos 		= _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
   6437  1.3  christos 					      elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
   6438  1.3  christos 					      toff);
   6439  1.3  christos 
   6440  1.1  christos 	      if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
   6441  1.1  christos 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6442  1.3  christos 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6443  1.3  christos 	    }
   6444  1.8  christos 	  /* PLTREL24 addends are special.  */
   6445  1.8  christos 	  else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6446  1.8  christos 	    toff += irel->r_addend;
   6447  1.8  christos 
   6448  1.8  christos 	  /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses.  */
   6449  1.8  christos 	  if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6450  1.8  christos 	       && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
   6451  1.8  christos 	      || tsec->output_section == NULL
   6452  1.8  christos 	      || (tsec->owner != NULL
   6453  1.8  christos 		  && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
   6454  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6455  1.3  christos 
   6456  1.6  christos 	  roff = irel->r_offset;
   6457  1.3  christos 
   6458  1.3  christos 	  /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
   6459  1.3  christos 	     relocatable if the output section size is such that a
   6460  1.3  christos 	     fixup can be created at final link.
   6461  1.3  christos 	     The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
   6462  1.3  christos 	     of other fixups being needed at final link.  */
   6463  1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6464  1.3  christos 	      && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
   6465  1.3  christos 		  < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
   6466  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6467  1.3  christos 
   6468  1.1  christos 	  /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything.  */
   6469  1.3  christos 	  if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
   6470  1.3  christos 	      && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6471  1.5  christos 		  /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
   6472  1.3  christos 		     final link, so do not presume they remain in range.  */
   6473  1.3  christos 		  || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
   6474  1.3  christos 	    {
   6475  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
   6476  1.1  christos 
   6477  1.3  christos 	      symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
   6478  1.3  christos 	      reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
   6479  1.1  christos 	      if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
   6480  1.3  christos 		  < 2 * max_branch_offset)
   6481  1.3  christos 		continue;
   6482  1.3  christos 	    }
   6483  1.3  christos 
   6484  1.3  christos 	  /* Look for an existing fixup to this address.  */
   6485  1.1  christos 	  for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
   6486  1.6  christos 	    if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
   6487  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6488  1.3  christos 
   6489  1.3  christos 	  if (f == NULL)
   6490  1.3  christos 	    {
   6491  1.3  christos 	      size_t size;
   6492  1.3  christos 	      unsigned long stub_rtype;
   6493  1.3  christos 
   6494  1.3  christos 	      val = trampoff - roff;
   6495  1.3  christos 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6496  1.3  christos 		/* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline.  Don't try to add
   6497  1.7  christos 		   one.  We'll report an error later.  */
   6498  1.3  christos 		continue;
   6499  1.3  christos 
   6500  1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6501  1.3  christos 		{
   6502  1.3  christos 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
   6503  1.3  christos 		  insn_offset = 12;
   6504  1.1  christos 		}
   6505  1.3  christos 	      else
   6506  1.3  christos 		{
   6507  1.3  christos 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   6508  1.3  christos 		  insn_offset = 0;
   6509  1.3  christos 		}
   6510  1.3  christos 	      stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
   6511  1.3  christos 	      if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
   6512  1.3  christos 		  || tsec == htab->glink)
   6513  1.3  christos 		{
   6514  1.3  christos 		  stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
   6515  1.3  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6516  1.5  christos 		    stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
   6517  1.3  christos 		}
   6518  1.3  christos 
   6519  1.3  christos 	      /* Hijack the old relocation.  Since we need two
   6520  1.5  christos 		 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc.  */
   6521  1.1  christos 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
   6522  1.3  christos 					   stub_rtype);
   6523  1.3  christos 	      irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
   6524  1.3  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6525  1.1  christos 		  && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   6526  1.1  christos 		irel->r_addend = 0;
   6527  1.3  christos 
   6528  1.3  christos 	      /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section.  */
   6529  1.3  christos 	      f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
   6530  1.3  christos 	      f->next = branch_fixups;
   6531  1.3  christos 	      f->tsec = tsec;
   6532  1.3  christos 	      f->toff = toff;
   6533  1.3  christos 	      f->trampoff = trampoff;
   6534  1.3  christos 	      branch_fixups = f;
   6535  1.3  christos 
   6536  1.3  christos 	      trampoff += size;
   6537  1.3  christos 	      changes++;
   6538  1.3  christos 	    }
   6539  1.3  christos 	  else
   6540  1.3  christos 	    {
   6541  1.1  christos 	      val = f->trampoff - roff;
   6542  1.3  christos 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6543  1.1  christos 		continue;
   6544  1.1  christos 
   6545  1.1  christos 	      /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here.  */
   6546  1.3  christos 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6547  1.3  christos 	    }
   6548  1.3  christos 
   6549  1.3  christos 	  /* Get the section contents.  */
   6550  1.3  christos 	  if (contents == NULL)
   6551  1.3  christos 	    {
   6552  1.3  christos 	      /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
   6553  1.3  christos 	      if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
   6554  1.3  christos 		contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
   6555  1.3  christos 	      /* Go get them off disk.  */
   6556  1.3  christos 	      else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
   6557  1.3  christos 		goto error_return;
   6558  1.1  christos 	    }
   6559  1.3  christos 
   6560  1.3  christos 	  /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline.  */
   6561  1.3  christos 	  hit_addr = contents + roff;
   6562  1.3  christos 	  switch (r_type)
   6563  1.3  christos 	    {
   6564  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6565  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6566  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6567  1.3  christos 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6568  1.1  christos 	      t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
   6569  1.1  christos 	      t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
   6570  1.5  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6571  1.1  christos 	      break;
   6572  1.5  christos 
   6573  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6574  1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6575  1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6576  1.3  christos 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6577  1.1  christos 	      t0 &= ~0xfffc;
   6578  1.3  christos 	      t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
   6579  1.3  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6580  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6581  1.6  christos 	    }
   6582  1.3  christos 	}
   6583  1.3  christos 
   6584  1.3  christos       while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6585  1.3  christos 	{
   6586  1.3  christos 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6587  1.3  christos 	  branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6588  1.3  christos 	  free (f);
   6589  1.3  christos 	}
   6590  1.3  christos     }
   6591  1.3  christos 
   6592  1.3  christos   workaround_change = FALSE;
   6593  1.3  christos   newsize = trampoff;
   6594  1.3  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6595  1.3  christos       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6596  1.3  christos 	  || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
   6597  1.3  christos     {
   6598  1.3  christos       bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
   6599  1.3  christos       unsigned int crossings;
   6600  1.3  christos       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6601  1.3  christos 
   6602  1.3  christos       addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
   6603  1.3  christos       end_addr = addr + trampoff;
   6604  1.3  christos       addr &= -pagesize;
   6605  1.3  christos       crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6606  1.1  christos       if (crossings != 0)
   6607  1.3  christos 	{
   6608  1.3  christos 	  /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
   6609  1.1  christos 	     not cross a page.  Don't decrease size calculated on a
   6610  1.5  christos 	     previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout.  */
   6611  1.5  christos 	  newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
   6612  1.5  christos 	  newsize += crossings * 16;
   6613  1.5  christos 	  if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
   6614  1.5  christos 	    {
   6615  1.5  christos 	      relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
   6616  1.5  christos 	      workaround_change = TRUE;
   6617  1.5  christos 	    }
   6618  1.5  christos 	  /* Ensure relocate_section is called.  */
   6619  1.3  christos 	  isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   6620  1.1  christos 	}
   6621  1.1  christos       newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
   6622  1.1  christos     }
   6623  1.1  christos 
   6624  1.1  christos   if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6625  1.1  christos     {
   6626  1.1  christos       picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6627  1.1  christos       if (picfixup_size != 0)
   6628  1.1  christos 	relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
   6629  1.1  christos       newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6630  1.1  christos     }
   6631  1.1  christos 
   6632  1.1  christos   if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
   6633  1.1  christos     isec->size = newsize;
   6634  1.1  christos 
   6635  1.1  christos   if (isymbuf != NULL
   6636  1.1  christos       && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
   6637  1.1  christos     {
   6638  1.1  christos       if (! link_info->keep_memory)
   6639  1.1  christos 	free (isymbuf);
   6640  1.1  christos       else
   6641  1.1  christos 	{
   6642  1.1  christos 	  /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6643  1.1  christos 	  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
   6644  1.1  christos 	}
   6645  1.5  christos     }
   6646  1.1  christos 
   6647  1.1  christos   if (contents != NULL
   6648  1.1  christos       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6649  1.1  christos     {
   6650  1.1  christos       if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
   6651  1.1  christos 	free (contents);
   6652  1.1  christos       else
   6653  1.1  christos 	{
   6654  1.1  christos 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6655  1.1  christos 	  elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
   6656  1.1  christos 	}
   6657  1.1  christos     }
   6658  1.1  christos 
   6659  1.1  christos   changes += picfixup_size;
   6660  1.1  christos   if (changes != 0)
   6661  1.1  christos     {
   6662  1.1  christos       /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
   6663  1.1  christos 	 information for the trampolines.  */
   6664  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   6665  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
   6666  1.1  christos 						  * sizeof (*new_relocs));
   6667  1.1  christos       unsigned ix;
   6668  1.1  christos 
   6669  1.1  christos       if (!new_relocs)
   6670  1.1  christos 	goto error_return;
   6671  1.1  christos       memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
   6672  1.3  christos 	      isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
   6673  1.3  christos       for (ix = changes; ix--;)
   6674  1.1  christos 	{
   6675  1.1  christos 	  irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
   6676  1.3  christos 
   6677  1.1  christos 	  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6678  1.1  christos 	}
   6679  1.1  christos       if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
   6680  1.5  christos 	free (internal_relocs);
   6681  1.3  christos       elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
   6682  1.5  christos       isec->reloc_count += changes;
   6683  1.5  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
   6684  1.3  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   6685  1.3  christos     }
   6686  1.1  christos   else if (internal_relocs != NULL
   6687  1.1  christos 	   && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6688  1.1  christos     free (internal_relocs);
   6689  1.1  christos 
   6690  1.1  christos   *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
   6691  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   6692  1.1  christos 
   6693  1.1  christos  error_return:
   6694  1.1  christos   while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6695  1.1  christos     {
   6696  1.1  christos       struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6697  1.1  christos       branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6698  1.1  christos       free (f);
   6699  1.1  christos     }
   6700  1.1  christos   if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
   6701  1.1  christos     free (isymbuf);
   6702  1.1  christos   if (contents != NULL
   6703  1.1  christos       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6704  1.1  christos     free (contents);
   6705  1.1  christos   if (internal_relocs != NULL
   6706  1.1  christos       && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6707  1.1  christos     free (internal_relocs);
   6708  1.1  christos   return FALSE;
   6709  1.1  christos }
   6710  1.1  christos 
   6711  1.1  christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
   6713  1.1  christos    discarded sections.  */
   6714  1.1  christos 
   6715  1.1  christos static unsigned int
   6716  1.1  christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
   6717  1.1  christos {
   6718  1.1  christos   if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
   6719  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6720  1.1  christos 
   6721  1.1  christos   if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
   6722  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6723  1.1  christos 
   6724  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
   6725  1.1  christos }
   6726  1.1  christos 
   6727  1.1  christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section.  */
   6729  1.1  christos 
   6730  1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   6731  1.1  christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
   6732  1.1  christos 				   elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   6733  1.1  christos 				   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   6734  1.1  christos 				   bfd_vma relocation,
   6735  1.1  christos 				   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   6736  1.1  christos {
   6737  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   6738  1.1  christos 
   6739  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   6740  1.1  christos 
   6741  1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   6742  1.1  christos     {
   6743  1.1  christos       /* Handle global symbol.  */
   6744  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   6745  1.1  christos 
   6746  1.1  christos       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   6747  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
   6748  1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
   6749  1.1  christos     }
   6750  1.1  christos   else
   6751  1.1  christos     {
   6752  1.1  christos       /* Handle local symbol.  */
   6753  1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   6754  1.1  christos 
   6755  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
   6756  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
   6757  1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
   6758  1.1  christos     }
   6759  1.1  christos 
   6760  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
   6761  1.1  christos 							rel->r_addend,
   6762  1.1  christos 							lsect);
   6763  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   6764  1.1  christos 
   6765  1.1  christos   /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
   6766  1.1  christos      as a "written" flag.  */
   6767  1.1  christos   if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
   6768  1.1  christos     {
   6769  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
   6770  1.1  christos 		  relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
   6771  1.1  christos 		  lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
   6772  1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
   6773  1.1  christos     }
   6774  1.1  christos 
   6775  1.1  christos   relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
   6776  1.1  christos 		+ lsect->section->output_offset
   6777  1.1  christos 		+ linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
   6778  1.8  christos 		- SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
   6779  1.8  christos 
   6780  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   6781  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr,
   6782  1.1  christos 	   "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
   6783  1.1  christos 	   lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
   6784  1.1  christos #endif
   6785  1.8  christos 
   6786  1.8  christos   return relocation;
   6787  1.8  christos }
   6788  1.8  christos 
   6789  1.8  christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
   6790  1.8  christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
   6791  1.8  christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
   6792  1.8  christos 
   6793  1.8  christos static void
   6794  1.8  christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
   6795  1.8  christos 		  asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
   6796  1.8  christos 		  struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6797  1.8  christos {
   6798  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6799  1.8  christos   bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
   6800  1.8  christos   bfd_vma plt;
   6801  1.8  christos   unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   6802  1.8  christos 
   6803  1.8  christos   if (h != NULL
   6804  1.8  christos       && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6805  1.8  christos       && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   6806  1.8  christos     {
   6807  1.8  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
   6808  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6809  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
   6810  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6811  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
   6812  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6813  1.6  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
   6814  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6815  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
   6816  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6817  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
   6818  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6819  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
   6820  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6821  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   6822  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6823  1.1  christos     }
   6824  1.1  christos 
   6825  1.1  christos   plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
   6826  1.1  christos 	 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
   6827  1.8  christos 	 + plt_sec->output_offset);
   6828  1.1  christos 
   6829  1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   6830  1.1  christos     {
   6831  1.1  christos       bfd_vma got = 0;
   6832  1.1  christos 
   6833  1.1  christos       if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   6834  1.1  christos 	got = (ent->addend
   6835  1.1  christos 	       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   6836  1.1  christos 	       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   6837  1.1  christos       else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   6838  1.1  christos 	got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   6839  1.1  christos 
   6840  1.8  christos       plt -= got;
   6841  1.8  christos 
   6842  1.8  christos       if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   6843  1.8  christos 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6844  1.8  christos       else
   6845  1.8  christos 	{
   6846  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6847  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   6848  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6849  1.1  christos 	}
   6850  1.1  christos     }
   6851  1.1  christos   else
   6852  1.1  christos     {
   6853  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6854  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6855  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6856  1.1  christos     }
   6857  1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6858  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
   6859  1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6860  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   6861  1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6862  1.1  christos   while (p < end)
   6863  1.1  christos     {
   6864  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   6865  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6866  1.1  christos     }
   6867  1.1  christos }
   6868  1.1  christos 
   6869  1.1  christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically.  */
   6870  1.1  christos 
   6871  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6872  1.1  christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6873  1.1  christos {
   6874  1.1  christos   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   6875  1.1  christos 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   6876  1.1  christos 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
   6877  1.1  christos 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
   6878  1.1  christos }
   6879  1.1  christos 
   6880  1.1  christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
   6881  1.1  christos    the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0.  If
   6882  1.1  christos    REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG.  */
   6883  1.1  christos 
   6884  1.1  christos unsigned int
   6885  1.1  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6886  1.1  christos {
   6887  1.1  christos   unsigned int rtra;
   6888  1.1  christos 
   6889  1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
   6890  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6891  1.1  christos 
   6892  1.1  christos   if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6893  1.1  christos     rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
   6894  1.1  christos   else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6895  1.1  christos     rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
   6896  1.1  christos   else
   6897  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6898  1.1  christos 
   6899  1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
   6900  1.1  christos     /* add -> addi.  */
   6901  1.1  christos     insn = 14 << 26;
   6902  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
   6903  1.1  christos 	   && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
   6904  1.1  christos 	       || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
   6905  1.1  christos 		   && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
   6906  1.1  christos     /* load and store indexed -> dform.  */
   6907  1.1  christos     insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
   6908  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
   6909  1.1  christos     /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu.  */
   6910  1.1  christos     insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
   6911  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
   6912  1.1  christos     /* lwax -> lwa.  */
   6913  1.1  christos     insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
   6914  1.1  christos   else
   6915  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6916  1.1  christos   insn |= rtra;
   6917  1.1  christos   return insn;
   6918  1.1  christos }
   6919  1.1  christos 
   6920  1.1  christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
   6921  1.1  christos    the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
   6922  1.1  christos    thread pointer REG operand removed.  Otherwise return 0.  */
   6923  1.1  christos 
   6924  1.1  christos unsigned int
   6925  1.1  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6926  1.1  christos {
   6927  1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
   6928  1.1  christos       && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
   6929  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
   6930  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   6931  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   6932  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   6933  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   6934  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   6935  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   6936  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   6937  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   6938  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   6939  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   6940  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   6941  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   6942  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   6943  1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   6944  1.1  christos 	      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   6945  1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   6946  1.1  christos 	      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
   6947  1.1  christos     {
   6948  1.1  christos       insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   6949  1.1  christos     }
   6950  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
   6951  1.1  christos 	   && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
   6952  1.1  christos 	       || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
   6953  1.1  christos 	       || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
   6954  1.1  christos     {
   6955  1.1  christos       insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
   6956  1.1  christos       insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
   6957  1.1  christos       if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
   6958  1.1  christos 	insn -= 2 >> 26;  /* convert to ori,oris */
   6959  1.1  christos     }
   6960  1.1  christos   else
   6961  1.6  christos     insn = 0;
   6962  1.6  christos   return insn;
   6963  1.6  christos }
   6964  1.1  christos 
   6965  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6966  1.1  christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
   6967  1.1  christos {
   6968  1.1  christos   return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
   6969  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
   6970  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
   6971  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
   6972  1.1  christos }
   6973  1.1  christos 
   6974  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6975  1.1  christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
   6976  1.1  christos {
   6977  1.1  christos   return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
   6978  1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
   6979  1.1  christos 	      && (insn & 3) == 1));
   6980  1.1  christos }
   6981  1.1  christos 
   6982  1.1  christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
   6983  1.1  christos    to handle the relocations for a section.
   6984  1.1  christos 
   6985  1.1  christos    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
   6986  1.1  christos    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
   6987  1.1  christos    zero.
   6988  1.1  christos 
   6989  1.1  christos    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
   6990  1.1  christos    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
   6991  1.1  christos    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
   6992  1.1  christos    necessary.
   6993  1.1  christos 
   6994  1.1  christos    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
   6995  1.1  christos    address or the reloc symbol index.
   6996  1.1  christos 
   6997  1.1  christos    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
   6998  1.1  christos 
   6999  1.1  christos    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
   7000  1.1  christos    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
   7001  1.1  christos 
   7002  1.1  christos    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
   7003  1.1  christos    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
   7004  1.1  christos 
   7005  1.1  christos    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
   7006  1.1  christos    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
   7007  1.1  christos    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
   7008  1.1  christos    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
   7009  1.6  christos    accordingly.  */
   7010  1.1  christos 
   7011  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   7012  1.1  christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
   7013  1.1  christos 			  struct bfd_link_info *info,
   7014  1.1  christos 			  bfd *input_bfd,
   7015  1.7  christos 			  asection *input_section,
   7016  1.1  christos 			  bfd_byte *contents,
   7017  1.5  christos 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
   7018  1.5  christos 			  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
   7019  1.1  christos 			  asection **local_sections)
   7020  1.1  christos {
   7021  1.8  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   7022  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   7023  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   7024  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   7025  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
   7026  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
   7027  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
   7028  1.8  christos   asection *got2;
   7029  1.8  christos   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
   7030  1.8  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   7031  1.8  christos   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
   7032  1.8  christos   bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
   7033  1.8  christos   unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
   7034  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   7035  1.1  christos 
   7036  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   7037  1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
   7038  1.1  christos 		      "%ld relocations%s",
   7039  1.1  christos 		      input_bfd, input_section,
   7040  1.1  christos 		      (long) input_section->reloc_count,
   7041  1.1  christos 		      (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
   7042  1.1  christos #endif
   7043  1.1  christos 
   7044  1.1  christos   if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
   7045  1.1  christos     {
   7046  1.6  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   7047  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   7048  1.1  christos     }
   7049  1.5  christos 
   7050  1.5  christos   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
   7051  1.6  christos 
   7052  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   7053  1.6  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   7054  1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   7055  1.1  christos 
   7056  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   7057  1.1  christos   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
   7058  1.1  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
   7059  1.1  christos   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
   7060  1.1  christos   /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
   7061  1.1  christos      specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'.  */
   7062  1.1  christos   is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
   7063  1.1  christos 		    && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
   7064  1.1  christos 				".tls_vars"));
   7065  1.1  christos   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
   7066  1.8  christos     relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
   7067  1.1  christos   rel = wrel = relocs;
   7068  1.1  christos   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
   7069  1.8  christos   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
   7070  1.3  christos     {
   7071  1.1  christos       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   7072  1.6  christos       bfd_vma addend;
   7073  1.1  christos       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
   7074  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   7075  1.1  christos       asection *sec;
   7076  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   7077  1.1  christos       const char *sym_name;
   7078  1.1  christos       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   7079  1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx;
   7080  1.1  christos       bfd_vma relocation;
   7081  1.1  christos       bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
   7082  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
   7083  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean warned;
   7084  1.1  christos       unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
   7085  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
   7086  1.1  christos       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
   7087  1.1  christos 
   7088  1.1  christos     again:
   7089  1.1  christos       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   7090  1.1  christos       sym = NULL;
   7091  1.1  christos       sec = NULL;
   7092  1.1  christos       h = NULL;
   7093  1.1  christos       unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7094  1.1  christos       warned = FALSE;
   7095  1.1  christos       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   7096  1.1  christos 
   7097  1.1  christos       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7098  1.1  christos 	{
   7099  1.1  christos 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
   7100  1.1  christos 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
   7101  1.1  christos 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
   7102  1.1  christos 
   7103  1.1  christos 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
   7104  1.1  christos 	}
   7105  1.1  christos       else
   7106  1.1  christos 	{
   7107  1.1  christos 	  bfd_boolean ignored;
   7108  1.1  christos 
   7109  1.6  christos 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
   7110  1.6  christos 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
   7111  1.8  christos 				   h, sec, relocation,
   7112  1.6  christos 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
   7113  1.6  christos 
   7114  1.6  christos 	  sym_name = h->root.root.string;
   7115  1.6  christos 	}
   7116  1.6  christos 
   7117  1.8  christos       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
   7118  1.6  christos 	{
   7119  1.6  christos 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
   7120  1.6  christos 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
   7121  1.6  christos 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
   7122  1.6  christos 	  howto = NULL;
   7123  1.6  christos 	  if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7124  1.6  christos 	    howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7125  1.1  christos 
   7126  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
   7127  1.6  christos 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
   7128  1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
   7129  1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
   7130  1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
   7131  1.1  christos 
   7132  1.1  christos 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
   7133  1.1  christos 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
   7134  1.1  christos 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
   7135  1.1  christos 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
   7136  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   7137  1.3  christos 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
   7138  1.3  christos 	    wrel--;
   7139  1.3  christos 
   7140  1.6  christos 	  continue;
   7141  1.1  christos 	}
   7142  1.1  christos 
   7143  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   7144  1.1  christos 	{
   7145  1.1  christos 	  if (got2 != NULL
   7146  1.1  christos 	      && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7147  1.1  christos 	      && rel->r_addend != 0)
   7148  1.1  christos 	    {
   7149  1.1  christos 	      /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   7150  1.1  christos 		 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.  */
   7151  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
   7152  1.1  christos 	    }
   7153  1.1  christos 	  if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
   7154  1.1  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
   7155  1.1  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
   7156  1.1  christos 	    goto copy_reloc;
   7157  1.1  christos 	}
   7158  1.1  christos 
   7159  1.1  christos       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
   7160  1.1  christos 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
   7161  1.1  christos 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
   7162  1.1  christos 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
   7163  1.1  christos       tls_mask = 0;
   7164  1.1  christos       tls_gd = 0;
   7165  1.1  christos       if (h != NULL)
   7166  1.1  christos 	tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
   7167  1.1  christos       else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   7168  1.1  christos 	{
   7169  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7170  1.1  christos 	  char *lgot_masks;
   7171  1.1  christos 	  local_plt
   7172  1.1  christos 	    = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7173  1.1  christos 	  lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7174  1.1  christos 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   7175  1.1  christos 	}
   7176  1.1  christos 
   7177  1.1  christos       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
   7178  1.1  christos       if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
   7179  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
   7180  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
   7181  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
   7182  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
   7183  1.7  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
   7184  1.6  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
   7185  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
   7186  1.1  christos 	abort ();
   7187  1.7  christos       switch (r_type)
   7188  1.6  christos 	{
   7189  1.1  christos 	default:
   7190  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7191  1.1  christos 
   7192  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7193  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7194  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7195  1.1  christos 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
   7196  1.1  christos 	    {
   7197  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7198  1.1  christos 
   7199  1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7200  1.7  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7201  1.1  christos 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
   7202  1.1  christos 	      insn |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis 0,2,0 */
   7203  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7204  1.7  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7205  1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7206  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7207  1.1  christos 	    }
   7208  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7209  1.1  christos 
   7210  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7211  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7212  1.1  christos 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
   7213  1.1  christos 	    {
   7214  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7215  1.1  christos 
   7216  1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7217  1.1  christos 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
   7218  1.1  christos 	      if (insn == 0)
   7219  1.1  christos 		abort ();
   7220  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7221  1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7222  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7223  1.1  christos 
   7224  1.1  christos 	      /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
   7225  1.1  christos 		 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
   7226  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7227  1.1  christos 	    }
   7228  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7229  1.1  christos 
   7230  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7231  1.5  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7232  1.7  christos 	  tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
   7233  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
   7234  1.1  christos 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
   7235  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7236  1.1  christos 
   7237  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7238  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7239  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
   7240  1.1  christos 	    {
   7241  1.1  christos 	    tls_gdld_hi:
   7242  1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7243  1.1  christos 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7244  1.1  christos 			  + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7245  1.1  christos 	      else
   7246  1.1  christos 		{
   7247  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
   7248  1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7249  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7250  1.1  christos 		}
   7251  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7252  1.1  christos 	    }
   7253  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7254  1.1  christos 
   7255  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7256  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7257  1.1  christos 	  tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
   7258  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
   7259  1.1  christos 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
   7260  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7261  1.1  christos 
   7262  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7263  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7264  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
   7265  1.5  christos 	    {
   7266  1.5  christos 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
   7267  1.5  christos 	      bfd_vma offset;
   7268  1.5  christos 
   7269  1.7  christos 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
   7270  1.5  christos 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   7271  1.1  christos 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
   7272  1.1  christos 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
   7273  1.1  christos 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
   7274  1.5  christos 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
   7275  1.1  christos 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
   7276  1.1  christos 	      if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
   7277  1.1  christos 		  && rel + 1 < relend
   7278  1.1  christos 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
   7279  1.1  christos 					      htab->tls_get_addr))
   7280  1.7  christos 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
   7281  1.1  christos 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
   7282  1.1  christos 		 the destination reg.  It may be something other than
   7283  1.1  christos 		 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
   7284  1.1  christos 		 intervening code.  */
   7285  1.1  christos 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7286  1.1  christos 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7287  1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7288  1.1  christos 		{
   7289  1.5  christos 		  /* IE */
   7290  1.5  christos 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
   7291  1.1  christos 		  insn1 |= 32 << 26;	/* lwz */
   7292  1.1  christos 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   7293  1.1  christos 		    {
   7294  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7295  1.1  christos 		      insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7296  1.1  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7297  1.1  christos 		    }
   7298  1.1  christos 		  r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7299  1.1  christos 			    + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7300  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7301  1.1  christos 		}
   7302  1.1  christos 	      else
   7303  1.1  christos 		{
   7304  1.1  christos 		  /* LE */
   7305  1.1  christos 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
   7306  1.1  christos 		  insn1 |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis r,2,0 */
   7307  1.1  christos 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
   7308  1.1  christos 		    {
   7309  1.1  christos 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
   7310  1.1  christos 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7311  1.1  christos 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7312  1.1  christos 			   r_symndx++)
   7313  1.1  christos 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7314  1.1  christos 			  break;
   7315  1.7  christos 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7316  1.1  christos 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7317  1.1  christos 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7318  1.7  christos 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7319  1.1  christos 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7320  1.1  christos 					  + sec->output_offset
   7321  1.1  christos 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7322  1.1  christos 		    }
   7323  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7324  1.6  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7325  1.1  christos 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   7326  1.1  christos 		    {
   7327  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7328  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
   7329  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   7330  1.8  christos 		      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7331  1.8  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7332  1.1  christos 		    }
   7333  1.1  christos 		}
   7334  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
   7335  1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7336  1.8  christos 	      if (tls_gd == 0)
   7337  1.8  christos 		{
   7338  1.8  christos 		  /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc.  Start over
   7339  1.8  christos 		     in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
   7340  1.8  christos 		  goto again;
   7341  1.8  christos 		}
   7342  1.8  christos 	    }
   7343  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7344  1.1  christos 
   7345  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7346  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7347  1.1  christos 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
   7348  1.1  christos 	    {
   7349  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7350  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
   7351  1.1  christos 
   7352  1.1  christos 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7353  1.1  christos 		{
   7354  1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
   7355  1.1  christos 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7356  1.1  christos 		  break;
   7357  1.7  christos 		}
   7358  1.1  christos 
   7359  1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPRELGD) != 0)
   7360  1.1  christos 		{
   7361  1.1  christos 		  /* IE */
   7362  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7363  1.1  christos 		  insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7364  1.1  christos 		}
   7365  1.8  christos 	      else
   7366  1.8  christos 		{
   7367  1.1  christos 		  /* LE */
   7368  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7369  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7370  1.8  christos 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7371  1.8  christos 		}
   7372  1.8  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7373  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7374  1.8  christos 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7375  1.8  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7376  1.8  christos 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7377  1.1  christos 	    }
   7378  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7379  1.1  christos 
   7380  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7381  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7382  1.1  christos 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
   7383  1.1  christos 	    {
   7384  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7385  1.1  christos 
   7386  1.1  christos 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7387  1.1  christos 		{
   7388  1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7389  1.1  christos 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7390  1.1  christos 		  break;
   7391  1.1  christos 		}
   7392  1.1  christos 
   7393  1.7  christos 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7394  1.1  christos 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7395  1.1  christos 		   r_symndx++)
   7396  1.1  christos 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7397  1.1  christos 		  break;
   7398  1.6  christos 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7399  1.1  christos 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7400  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7401  1.1  christos 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7402  1.1  christos 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7403  1.1  christos 				  + sec->output_offset
   7404  1.1  christos 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7405  1.1  christos 
   7406  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7407  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7408  1.1  christos 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7409  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
   7410  1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7411  1.1  christos 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7412  1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7413  1.1  christos 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7414  1.7  christos 	      goto again;
   7415  1.1  christos 	    }
   7416  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7417  1.1  christos 	}
   7418  1.1  christos 
   7419  1.1  christos       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
   7420  1.8  christos       branch_bit = 0;
   7421  1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   7422  1.7  christos 	{
   7423  1.1  christos 	default:
   7424  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7425  1.1  christos 
   7426  1.1  christos 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
   7427  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   7428  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   7429  1.1  christos 	  branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7430  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   7431  1.1  christos 
   7432  1.1  christos 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
   7433  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   7434  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   7435  1.1  christos 	  {
   7436  1.8  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   7437  1.8  christos 
   7438  1.8  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7439  1.8  christos 	    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7440  1.8  christos 	    insn |= branch_bit;
   7441  1.8  christos 
   7442  1.8  christos 	    from = (rel->r_offset
   7443  1.8  christos 		    + input_section->output_offset
   7444  1.8  christos 		    + input_section->output_section->vma);
   7445  1.8  christos 
   7446  1.8  christos 	    /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
   7447  1.8  christos 	    if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
   7448  1.8  christos 	      insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7449  1.8  christos 
   7450  1.8  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7451  1.8  christos 	  }
   7452  1.8  christos 	  break;
   7453  1.8  christos 
   7454  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   7455  1.8  christos 	  {
   7456  1.8  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   7457  1.8  christos 
   7458  1.8  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7459  1.8  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7460  1.8  christos 	    if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
   7461  1.8  christos 		&& (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
   7462  1.1  christos 	      {
   7463  1.1  christos 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   7464  1.5  christos 		  {
   7465  1.5  christos 		    /* Convert addis to lis.  */
   7466  1.5  christos 		    insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   7467  1.5  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7468  1.5  christos 				contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7469  1.5  christos 		  }
   7470  1.5  christos 	      }
   7471  1.5  christos 	    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   7472  1.5  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   7473  1.5  christos 		(_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
   7474  1.5  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7475  1.5  christos 		 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
   7476  1.5  christos 	  }
   7477  1.5  christos 	  break;
   7478  1.7  christos 	}
   7479  1.5  christos 
   7480  1.5  christos       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   7481  1.5  christos 	  && h != NULL
   7482  1.5  christos 	  && !h->def_regular
   7483  1.5  christos 	  && h->protected_def
   7484  1.5  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   7485  1.5  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   7486  1.5  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   7487  1.5  christos 	{
   7488  1.5  christos 	  /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
   7489  1.5  christos 	     variable defined in a shared library to PIC.  */
   7490  1.5  christos 	  unsigned int insn;
   7491  1.5  christos 
   7492  1.5  christos 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   7493  1.5  christos 	    {
   7494  1.7  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7495  1.5  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7496  1.5  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
   7497  1.7  christos 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
   7498  1.5  christos 		{
   7499  1.7  christos 		  bfd_byte *p;
   7500  1.7  christos 		  bfd_vma off;
   7501  1.5  christos 		  bfd_vma got_addr;
   7502  1.6  christos 
   7503  1.6  christos 		  p = (contents + input_section->size
   7504  1.6  christos 		       - relax_info->workaround_size
   7505  1.5  christos 		       - relax_info->picfixup_size
   7506  1.7  christos 		       + picfixup_size);
   7507  1.7  christos 		  off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7508  1.5  christos 		  if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
   7509  1.5  christos 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7510  1.5  christos 		      (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
   7511  1.5  christos 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   7512  1.5  christos 
   7513  1.5  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
   7514  1.7  christos 			      contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7515  1.5  christos 		  got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7516  1.7  christos 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7517  1.5  christos 			      + (h->got.offset & ~1));
   7518  1.5  christos 		  wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
   7519  1.5  christos 		  wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   7520  1.5  christos 		  wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
   7521  1.5  christos 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7522  1.6  christos 		  insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   7523  1.6  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   7524  1.5  christos 
   7525  1.6  christos 		  /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT.  */
   7526  1.5  christos 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7527  1.5  christos 		  insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
   7528  1.5  christos 		  insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
   7529  1.5  christos 		  insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
   7530  1.5  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
   7531  1.5  christos 
   7532  1.8  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
   7533  1.7  christos 		  picfixup_size += 12;
   7534  1.8  christos 
   7535  1.8  christos 		  /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
   7536  1.8  christos 		     output is reasonable.  */
   7537  1.5  christos 		  memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
   7538  1.5  christos 		  wrel++, rel++;
   7539  1.5  christos 		  rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
   7540  1.5  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   7541  1.7  christos 		  rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
   7542  1.5  christos 
   7543  1.5  christos 		  /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
   7544  1.5  christos 		     dynamic reloc.  */
   7545  1.5  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
   7546  1.5  christos 		}
   7547  1.5  christos 	      else
   7548  1.5  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   7549  1.5  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7550  1.5  christos 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7551  1.5  christos 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7552  1.5  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7553  1.5  christos 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
   7554  1.5  christos 	    }
   7555  1.5  christos 	  else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
   7556  1.5  christos 	    {
   7557  1.5  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7558  1.5  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7559  1.5  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26    /* addi */
   7560  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   7561  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   7562  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   7563  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   7564  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   7565  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   7566  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   7567  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   7568  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   7569  1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   7570  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   7571  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   7572  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   7573  1.5  christos 		  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   7574  1.5  christos 		      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   7575  1.5  christos 		  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   7576  1.5  christos 		      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
   7577  1.1  christos 		{
   7578  1.1  christos 		  /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any.  */
   7579  1.1  christos 		  relocation = 0;
   7580  1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7581  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
   7582  1.1  christos 		}
   7583  1.1  christos 	      else
   7584  1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   7585  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7586  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7587  1.1  christos 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7588  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7589  1.1  christos 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
   7590  1.1  christos 	    }
   7591  1.1  christos 	}
   7592  1.1  christos 
   7593  1.1  christos       ifunc = NULL;
   7594  1.1  christos       if (!htab->is_vxworks)
   7595  1.1  christos 	{
   7596  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   7597  1.1  christos 
   7598  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   7599  1.6  christos 	    {
   7600  1.8  christos 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7601  1.8  christos 		ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
   7602  1.8  christos 	    }
   7603  1.8  christos 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
   7604  1.1  christos 		   && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7605  1.1  christos 	    {
   7606  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7607  1.8  christos 
   7608  1.8  christos 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   7609  1.8  christos 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7610  1.8  christos 	      ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
   7611  1.1  christos 	    }
   7612  1.1  christos 
   7613  1.1  christos 	  ent = NULL;
   7614  1.1  christos 	  if (ifunc != NULL
   7615  1.1  christos 	      && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   7616  1.7  christos 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   7617  1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7618  1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7619  1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7620  1.7  christos 	    {
   7621  1.7  christos 	      addend = 0;
   7622  1.7  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7623  1.7  christos 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7624  1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7625  1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7626  1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7627  1.7  christos 		addend = rel->r_addend;
   7628  1.7  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
   7629  1.7  christos 	    }
   7630  1.7  christos 	  if (ent != NULL)
   7631  1.7  christos 	    {
   7632  1.7  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7633  1.7  christos 		  && ent->sec != got2
   7634  1.7  christos 		  && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
   7635  1.7  christos 		  && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7636  1.7  christos 		      || h == NULL
   7637  1.1  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1))
   7638  1.1  christos 		{
   7639  1.1  christos 		  /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
   7640  1.1  christos 		     for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
   7641  1.3  christos 		     finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
   7642  1.3  christos 		     apparently are using code compiled with
   7643  1.1  christos 		     -mbss-plt.  The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
   7644  1.1  christos 		     gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
   7645  1.1  christos 		     whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
   7646  1.1  christos 		     is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
   7647  1.7  christos 		     into .got2).  */
   7648  1.7  christos 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7649  1.1  christos 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7650  1.1  christos 		      (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
   7651  1.1  christos 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
   7652  1.1  christos 		}
   7653  1.1  christos 
   7654  1.8  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7655  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   7656  1.1  christos 		  || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7657  1.1  christos 		  || h == NULL
   7658  1.8  christos 		  || h->dynindx == -1)
   7659  1.8  christos 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   7660  1.8  christos 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   7661  1.8  christos 			      + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
   7662  1.8  christos 	      else
   7663  1.8  christos 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   7664  1.8  christos 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   7665  1.8  christos 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   7666  1.8  christos 	    }
   7667  1.8  christos 	}
   7668  1.8  christos 
   7669  1.8  christos       addend = rel->r_addend;
   7670  1.8  christos       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
   7671  1.8  christos       howto = NULL;
   7672  1.8  christos       if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7673  1.8  christos 	howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7674  1.8  christos 
   7675  1.8  christos       switch (r_type)
   7676  1.8  christos 	{
   7677  1.8  christos 	default:
   7678  1.8  christos 	  break;
   7679  1.8  christos 
   7680  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   7681  1.8  christos 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   7682  1.8  christos 	    {
   7683  1.8  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   7684  1.8  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   7685  1.8  christos 	      if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
   7686  1.8  christos 		  != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
   7687  1.8  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   7688  1.8  christos 		info->callbacks->minfo
   7689  1.8  christos 		  (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
   7690  1.8  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
   7691  1.8  christos 	      else
   7692  1.8  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   7693  1.1  christos 	    }
   7694  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7695  1.1  christos 
   7696  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   7697  1.8  christos 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   7698  1.8  christos 	    {
   7699  1.1  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   7700  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   7701  1.1  christos 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   7702  1.6  christos 	      insn |= 2 << 16;
   7703  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   7704  1.1  christos 	    }
   7705  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7706  1.1  christos 	}
   7707  1.1  christos 
   7708  1.1  christos       tls_type = 0;
   7709  1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   7710  1.1  christos 	{
   7711  1.6  christos 	default:
   7712  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7713  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   7714  1.1  christos 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
   7715  1.1  christos 
   7716  1.1  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7717  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   7718  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7719  1.1  christos 
   7720  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   7721  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7722  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7723  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7724  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   7725  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   7726  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   7727  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7728  1.1  christos 
   7729  1.1  christos 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
   7730  1.1  christos 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
   7731  1.1  christos 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
   7732  1.1  christos 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
   7733  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7734  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7735  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7736  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7737  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7738  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7739  1.1  christos 
   7740  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7741  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7742  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7743  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7744  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7745  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7746  1.1  christos 
   7747  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7748  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7749  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   7750  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   7751  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7752  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7753  1.1  christos 
   7754  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   7755  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   7756  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   7757  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   7758  1.7  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7759  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7760  1.1  christos 
   7761  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   7762  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   7763  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   7764  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   7765  1.1  christos 	  tls_mask = 0;
   7766  1.1  christos 	dogot:
   7767  1.1  christos 	  {
   7768  1.7  christos 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
   7769  1.7  christos 	       offset table.  */
   7770  1.7  christos 	    bfd_vma off;
   7771  1.8  christos 	    bfd_vma *offp;
   7772  1.1  christos 	    unsigned long indx;
   7773  1.1  christos 
   7774  1.1  christos 	    if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   7775  1.1  christos 	      abort ();
   7776  1.1  christos 
   7777  1.1  christos 	    indx = 0;
   7778  1.1  christos 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
   7779  1.1  christos 		&& (h == NULL
   7780  1.1  christos 		    || !h->def_dynamic))
   7781  1.1  christos 	      offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
   7782  1.1  christos 	    else if (h != NULL)
   7783  1.1  christos 	      {
   7784  1.1  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7785  1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1
   7786  1.1  christos 		    || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
   7787  1.1  christos 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7788  1.1  christos 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
   7789  1.1  christos 		     -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
   7790  1.1  christos 		     locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
   7791  1.1  christos 		     because of a version file.  */
   7792  1.1  christos 		  ;
   7793  1.1  christos 		else
   7794  1.1  christos 		  {
   7795  1.1  christos 		    indx = h->dynindx;
   7796  1.1  christos 		    unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7797  1.1  christos 		  }
   7798  1.1  christos 		offp = &h->got.offset;
   7799  1.8  christos 	      }
   7800  1.8  christos 	    else
   7801  1.8  christos 	      {
   7802  1.8  christos 		if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
   7803  1.1  christos 		  abort ();
   7804  1.1  christos 		offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
   7805  1.1  christos 	      }
   7806  1.1  christos 
   7807  1.1  christos 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4.  We use the
   7808  1.1  christos 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
   7809  1.1  christos 	       processed this entry.  */
   7810  1.1  christos 	    off = *offp;
   7811  1.1  christos 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
   7812  1.1  christos 	      off &= ~1;
   7813  1.1  christos 	    else
   7814  1.1  christos 	      {
   7815  1.1  christos 		unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7816  1.1  christos 				      ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
   7817  1.1  christos 						    | TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)
   7818  1.1  christos 				      : 0);
   7819  1.1  christos 
   7820  1.1  christos 		if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
   7821  1.1  christos 		  tls_m = TLS_LD;
   7822  1.1  christos 		else if (h == NULL
   7823  1.1  christos 			 || !h->def_dynamic)
   7824  1.1  christos 		  tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7825  1.1  christos 
   7826  1.1  christos 		/* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
   7827  1.1  christos 		   Initialize them all.  */
   7828  1.1  christos 		do
   7829  1.1  christos 		  {
   7830  1.1  christos 		    int tls_ty = 0;
   7831  1.1  christos 
   7832  1.1  christos 		    if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
   7833  1.1  christos 		      {
   7834  1.1  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7835  1.1  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7836  1.1  christos 		      }
   7837  1.1  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7838  1.7  christos 		      {
   7839  1.7  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7840  1.7  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
   7841  1.8  christos 		      }
   7842  1.8  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7843  1.8  christos 		      {
   7844  1.8  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7845  1.8  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
   7846  1.1  christos 		      }
   7847  1.7  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
   7848  1.1  christos 		      {
   7849  1.1  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7850  1.1  christos 			tls_m = 0;
   7851  1.7  christos 		      }
   7852  1.7  christos 
   7853  1.7  christos 		    /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker.  */
   7854  1.7  christos 		    if (indx != 0
   7855  1.7  christos 			|| (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7856  1.7  christos 			    && (h == NULL
   7857  1.7  christos 				|| !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)
   7858  1.7  christos 				|| offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
   7859  1.7  christos 			    && !(tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
   7860  1.1  christos 				 && bfd_link_executable (info)
   7861  1.1  christos 				 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
   7862  1.1  christos 		      {
   7863  1.1  christos 			asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   7864  1.1  christos 			bfd_byte * loc;
   7865  1.1  christos 
   7866  1.1  christos 			if (ifunc != NULL)
   7867  1.1  christos 			  {
   7868  1.1  christos 			    rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   7869  1.1  christos 			    if (indx == 0)
   7870  1.1  christos 			      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7871  1.1  christos 			    else if (is_static_defined (h))
   7872  1.1  christos 			      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7873  1.1  christos 			  }
   7874  1.1  christos 			outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7875  1.1  christos 					   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7876  1.1  christos 					   + off);
   7877  1.1  christos 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7878  1.1  christos 			if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7879  1.1  christos 			  {
   7880  1.1  christos 			    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
   7881  1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7882  1.1  christos 			      {
   7883  1.1  christos 				loc = rsec->contents;
   7884  1.1  christos 				loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
   7885  1.1  christos 					* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   7886  1.1  christos 				bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
   7887  1.1  christos 							   &outrel, loc);
   7888  1.1  christos 				outrel.r_offset += 4;
   7889  1.1  christos 				outrel.r_info
   7890  1.1  christos 				  = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7891  1.5  christos 			      }
   7892  1.5  christos 			  }
   7893  1.5  christos 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7894  1.5  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7895  1.5  christos 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
   7896  1.5  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
   7897  1.1  christos 			else if (indx != 0)
   7898  1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
   7899  1.1  christos 			else if (ifunc != NULL)
   7900  1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   7901  1.1  christos 			else
   7902  1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   7903  1.1  christos 			if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7904  1.1  christos 			  {
   7905  1.1  christos 			    outrel.r_addend += relocation;
   7906  1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
   7907  1.1  christos 			      {
   7908  1.1  christos 				if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7909  1.1  christos 				  outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7910  1.7  christos 				else
   7911  1.1  christos 				  outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
   7912  1.5  christos 			      }
   7913  1.5  christos 			  }
   7914  1.5  christos 			loc = rsec->contents;
   7915  1.5  christos 			loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
   7916  1.7  christos 				* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   7917  1.7  christos 			bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
   7918  1.7  christos 		      }
   7919  1.7  christos 
   7920  1.8  christos 		    /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
   7921  1.5  christos 		       emitting a reloc.  */
   7922  1.5  christos 		    else
   7923  1.1  christos 		      {
   7924  1.7  christos 			bfd_vma value = relocation;
   7925  1.1  christos 
   7926  1.7  christos 			if (tls_ty != 0)
   7927  1.7  christos 			  {
   7928  1.8  christos 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7929  1.1  christos 			      value = 0;
   7930  1.1  christos 			    else
   7931  1.7  christos 			      {
   7932  1.7  christos 				if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
   7933  1.1  christos 				  value = 0;
   7934  1.1  christos 				else
   7935  1.1  christos 				  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7936  1.1  christos 				if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
   7937  1.1  christos 				  value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
   7938  1.1  christos 			      }
   7939  1.1  christos 
   7940  1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7941  1.1  christos 			      {
   7942  1.1  christos 				bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7943  1.1  christos 					    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
   7944  1.1  christos 				value = 1;
   7945  1.1  christos 			      }
   7946  1.1  christos 			  }
   7947  1.1  christos 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7948  1.1  christos 				    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
   7949  1.1  christos 		      }
   7950  1.1  christos 
   7951  1.1  christos 		    off += 4;
   7952  1.1  christos 		    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7953  1.1  christos 		      off += 4;
   7954  1.1  christos 		  }
   7955  1.1  christos 		while (tls_m != 0);
   7956  1.1  christos 
   7957  1.1  christos 		off = *offp;
   7958  1.1  christos 		*offp = off | 1;
   7959  1.1  christos 	      }
   7960  1.1  christos 
   7961  1.1  christos 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
   7962  1.1  christos 	      abort ();
   7963  1.1  christos 
   7964  1.1  christos 	    if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
   7965  1.1  christos 	      {
   7966  1.1  christos 		if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7967  1.1  christos 		  {
   7968  1.1  christos 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
   7969  1.5  christos 			&& !(h == NULL
   7970  1.5  christos 			     || !h->def_dynamic))
   7971  1.6  christos 		      off += 8;
   7972  1.5  christos 		    if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7973  1.7  christos 		      {
   7974  1.7  christos 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7975  1.1  christos 			  off += 8;
   7976  1.1  christos 			if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7977  1.1  christos 			  {
   7978  1.1  christos 			    if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7979  1.1  christos 			      off += 4;
   7980  1.1  christos 			  }
   7981  1.1  christos 		      }
   7982  1.1  christos 		  }
   7983  1.1  christos 	      }
   7984  1.7  christos 
   7985  1.7  christos 	    /* If here for a picfixup, we're done.  */
   7986  1.1  christos 	    if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   7987  1.1  christos 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7988  1.1  christos 
   7989  1.1  christos 	    relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7990  1.3  christos 			  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7991  1.1  christos 			  + off
   7992  1.3  christos 			  - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
   7993  1.1  christos 
   7994  1.1  christos 	    /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
   7995  1.1  christos 	       x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
   7996  1.1  christos 	       generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
   7997  1.1  christos 	       got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m.  */
   7998  1.6  christos 	    if (addend != 0)
   7999  1.6  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   8000  1.6  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   8001  1.6  christos 		(_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
   8002  1.6  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8003  1.6  christos 		 howto->name,
   8004  1.6  christos 		 sym_name);
   8005  1.1  christos 	  }
   8006  1.7  christos 	  break;
   8007  1.7  christos 
   8008  1.7  christos 	  /* Relocations that need no special processing.  */
   8009  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   8010  1.7  christos 	  /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
   8011  1.7  christos 	     at a symbol not in this object.  */
   8012  1.7  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8013  1.7  christos 	    {
   8014  1.7  christos 	      (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
   8015  1.7  christos 						    h->root.root.string,
   8016  1.7  christos 						    input_bfd,
   8017  1.7  christos 						    input_section,
   8018  1.7  christos 						    rel->r_offset,
   8019  1.7  christos 						    TRUE);
   8020  1.7  christos 	      goto copy_reloc;
   8021  1.1  christos 	    }
   8022  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
   8023  1.1  christos 	    {
   8024  1.1  christos 	      /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
   8025  1.1  christos 		 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere.  More
   8026  1.1  christos 		 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
   8027  1.5  christos 		 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
   8028  1.5  christos 		 access the PLT.  The problem is that a call that is
   8029  1.1  christos 		 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
   8030  1.1  christos 		 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
   8031  1.1  christos 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section.  */
   8032  1.1  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   8033  1.1  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
   8034  1.1  christos 				      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8035  1.1  christos 				      h->root.root.string);
   8036  1.1  christos 	    }
   8037  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8038  1.1  christos 
   8039  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   8040  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   8041  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   8042  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8043  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8044  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   8045  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8046  1.7  christos 
   8047  1.1  christos 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
   8048  1.1  christos 	     object.  */
   8049  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   8050  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8051  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   8052  1.5  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8053  1.5  christos 	  if (h != NULL
   8054  1.1  christos 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   8055  1.8  christos 	      && h->dynindx == -1)
   8056  1.8  christos 	    {
   8057  1.1  christos 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
   8058  1.1  christos 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
   8059  1.1  christos 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
   8060  1.5  christos 		 defined before using them.  */
   8061  1.5  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
   8062  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8063  1.1  christos 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
   8064  1.1  christos 	      if (insn != 0)
   8065  1.5  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   8066  1.5  christos 	      break;
   8067  1.1  christos 	    }
   8068  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8069  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   8070  1.1  christos 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
   8071  1.1  christos 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
   8072  1.1  christos 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
   8073  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8074  1.1  christos 
   8075  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   8076  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8077  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   8078  1.6  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8079  1.1  christos 
   8080  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   8081  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8082  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   8083  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8084  1.1  christos 
   8085  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   8086  1.1  christos 	  relocation = 1;
   8087  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8088  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8089  1.1  christos 
   8090  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   8091  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   8092  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   8093  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8094  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8095  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8096  1.1  christos 
   8097  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   8098  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8099  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8100  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8101  1.1  christos 
   8102  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   8103  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8104  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8105  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   8106  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8107  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   8108  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   8109  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8110  1.1  christos 
   8111  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   8112  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   8113  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   8114  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   8115  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   8116  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   8117  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   8118  1.1  christos 	  /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
   8119  1.1  christos 	     handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker.  */
   8120  1.1  christos 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   8121  1.1  christos 	      || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8122  1.8  christos 	    break;
   8123  1.8  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8124  1.8  christos 
   8125  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   8126  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   8127  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   8128  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   8129  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   8130  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8131  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8132  1.1  christos 
   8133  1.7  christos 	dodyn:
   8134  1.7  christos 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   8135  1.1  christos 	      || is_vxworks_tls)
   8136  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8137  1.1  christos 
   8138  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   8139  1.1  christos 	      ? ((h == NULL
   8140  1.1  christos 		  || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   8141  1.1  christos 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
   8142  1.1  christos 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
   8143  1.1  christos 	      : (h != NULL
   8144  1.1  christos 		 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
   8145  1.1  christos 	    {
   8146  1.1  christos 	      int skip;
   8147  1.1  christos 	      bfd_byte *loc;
   8148  1.1  christos 	      asection *sreloc;
   8149  1.1  christos 	      long indx = 0;
   8150  1.1  christos 
   8151  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   8152  1.1  christos 	      fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
   8153  1.1  christos 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   8154  1.1  christos 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   8155  1.1  christos 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   8156  1.1  christos #endif
   8157  1.8  christos 
   8158  1.1  christos 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
   8159  1.7  christos 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
   8160  1.7  christos 		 time.  */
   8161  1.1  christos 	      skip = 0;
   8162  1.7  christos 	      outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
   8163  1.1  christos 							 input_section,
   8164  1.1  christos 							 rel->r_offset);
   8165  1.1  christos 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
   8166  1.1  christos 		  || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
   8167  1.1  christos 		skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
   8168  1.1  christos 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
   8169  1.1  christos 				  + input_section->output_offset);
   8170  1.1  christos 
   8171  1.1  christos 	      if (skip)
   8172  1.1  christos 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
   8173  1.1  christos 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   8174  1.1  christos 		{
   8175  1.1  christos 		  indx = h->dynindx;
   8176  1.1  christos 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
   8177  1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8178  1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8179  1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8180  1.1  christos 		}
   8181  1.1  christos 	      else
   8182  1.1  christos 		{
   8183  1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
   8184  1.1  christos 
   8185  1.1  christos 		  if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
   8186  1.7  christos 		    {
   8187  1.7  christos 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8188  1.1  christos 			{
   8189  1.1  christos 			  /* If we get here when building a static
   8190  1.1  christos 			     executable, then the libc startup function
   8191  1.1  christos 			     responsible for applying indirect function
   8192  1.1  christos 			     relocations is going to complain about
   8193  1.1  christos 			     the reloc type.
   8194  1.1  christos 			     If we get here when building a dynamic
   8195  1.1  christos 			     executable, it will be because we have
   8196  1.1  christos 			     a text relocation.  The dynamic loader
   8197  1.1  christos 			     will set the text segment writable and
   8198  1.1  christos 			     non-executable to apply text relocations.
   8199  1.1  christos 			     So we'll segfault when trying to run the
   8200  1.1  christos 			     indirection function to resolve the reloc.  */
   8201  1.1  christos 			  info->callbacks->einfo
   8202  1.1  christos 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8203  1.1  christos 			    (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
   8204  1.1  christos 			       "function %s unsupported\n"),
   8205  1.1  christos 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8206  1.1  christos 			     howto->name,
   8207  1.1  christos 			     sym_name);
   8208  1.1  christos 			  ret = FALSE;
   8209  1.1  christos 			}
   8210  1.1  christos 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
   8211  1.1  christos 			;
   8212  1.1  christos 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
   8213  1.1  christos 			{
   8214  1.1  christos 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8215  1.1  christos 			  ret = FALSE;
   8216  1.1  christos 			}
   8217  1.1  christos 		      else
   8218  1.1  christos 			{
   8219  1.1  christos 			  asection *osec;
   8220  1.1  christos 
   8221  1.1  christos 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
   8222  1.1  christos 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
   8223  1.1  christos 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
   8224  1.1  christos 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
   8225  1.1  christos 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
   8226  1.1  christos 			     FIXME: Why not always use a zero index?  */
   8227  1.1  christos 			  osec = sec->output_section;
   8228  1.1  christos 			  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8229  1.1  christos 			  if (indx == 0)
   8230  1.1  christos 			    {
   8231  1.1  christos 			      osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
   8232  1.1  christos 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8233  1.1  christos 			    }
   8234  1.1  christos 			  BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
   8235  1.7  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   8236  1.7  christos 			  if (indx == 0)
   8237  1.7  christos 			    printf ("indx=%ld section=%s flags=%08x name=%s\n",
   8238  1.7  christos 				    indx, osec->name, osec->flags,
   8239  1.7  christos 				    h->root.root.string);
   8240  1.7  christos #endif
   8241  1.7  christos 			}
   8242  1.7  christos 
   8243  1.7  christos 		      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8244  1.7  christos 		    }
   8245  1.7  christos 		  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8246  1.7  christos 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   8247  1.1  christos 		  else
   8248  1.1  christos 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   8249  1.1  christos 		}
   8250  1.1  christos 
   8251  1.1  christos 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   8252  1.6  christos 	      if (ifunc)
   8253  1.1  christos 		{
   8254  1.7  christos 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   8255  1.7  christos 		  if (indx == 0)
   8256  1.7  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8257  1.1  christos 		  else if (is_static_defined (h))
   8258  1.1  christos 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8259  1.1  christos 		}
   8260  1.1  christos 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   8261  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   8262  1.1  christos 
   8263  1.1  christos 	      loc = sreloc->contents;
   8264  1.1  christos 	      loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   8265  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
   8266  1.1  christos 
   8267  1.1  christos 	      if (skip == -1)
   8268  1.1  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8269  1.1  christos 
   8270  1.1  christos 	      /* This reloc will be computed at runtime.  Clear the memory
   8271  1.1  christos 		 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink.  */
   8272  1.1  christos 	      if (!skip)
   8273  1.1  christos 		{
   8274  1.6  christos 		  relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
   8275  1.1  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8276  1.1  christos 		  break;
   8277  1.1  christos 		}
   8278  1.1  christos 	    }
   8279  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8280  1.1  christos 
   8281  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   8282  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   8283  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   8284  1.7  christos 	    {
   8285  1.7  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8286  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
   8287  1.1  christos 
   8288  1.7  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   8289  1.1  christos 		{
   8290  1.1  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8291  1.1  christos 		    got2_addend = addend;
   8292  1.3  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8293  1.3  christos 		}
   8294  1.3  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
   8295  1.3  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8296  1.3  christos 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8297  1.6  christos 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   8298  1.3  christos 			      + ent->glink_offset);
   8299  1.3  christos 	      else
   8300  1.3  christos 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8301  1.3  christos 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8302  1.3  christos 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   8303  1.7  christos 	    }
   8304  1.7  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8305  1.7  christos 
   8306  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   8307  1.3  christos 	  {
   8308  1.3  christos 	    const int *stub;
   8309  1.3  christos 	    size_t size;
   8310  1.3  christos 	    size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
   8311  1.3  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   8312  1.3  christos 
   8313  1.3  christos 	    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8314  1.1  christos 	      {
   8315  1.1  christos 		relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
   8316  1.6  christos 			       + input_section->output_offset
   8317  1.3  christos 			       + rel->r_offset - 4);
   8318  1.1  christos 		stub = shared_stub_entry;
   8319  1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
   8320  1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
   8321  1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
   8322  1.7  christos 		stub += 3;
   8323  1.3  christos 		size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
   8324  1.3  christos 	      }
   8325  1.3  christos 	    else
   8326  1.3  christos 	      {
   8327  1.7  christos 		stub = stub_entry;
   8328  1.3  christos 		size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   8329  1.3  christos 	      }
   8330  1.3  christos 
   8331  1.3  christos 	    relocation += addend;
   8332  1.3  christos 	    if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   8333  1.3  christos 	      relocation = 0;
   8334  1.3  christos 
   8335  1.7  christos 	    /* First insn is HA, second is LO.  */
   8336  1.3  christos 	    insn = *stub++;
   8337  1.3  christos 	    insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   8338  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8339  1.1  christos 	    insn_offset += 4;
   8340  1.1  christos 
   8341  1.1  christos 	    insn = *stub++;
   8342  1.1  christos 	    insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
   8343  1.6  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8344  1.6  christos 	    insn_offset += 4;
   8345  1.6  christos 	    size -= 2;
   8346  1.6  christos 
   8347  1.6  christos 	    while (size != 0)
   8348  1.6  christos 	      {
   8349  1.6  christos 		insn = *stub++;
   8350  1.1  christos 		--size;
   8351  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8352  1.1  christos 		insn_offset += 4;
   8353  1.1  christos 	      }
   8354  1.1  christos 
   8355  1.1  christos 	    /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
   8356  1.1  christos 	       relocs to describe this relocation.  */
   8357  1.1  christos 	    BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
   8358  1.1  christos 	    /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
   8359  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
   8360  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   8361  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8362  1.1  christos 	    memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
   8363  1.1  christos 	    wrel++, rel++;
   8364  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_offset += 4;
   8365  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   8366  1.1  christos 	  }
   8367  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   8368  1.1  christos 
   8369  1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   8370  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   8371  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
   8372  1.1  christos 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
   8373  1.1  christos 	    {
   8374  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8375  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8376  1.1  christos 	    }
   8377  1.1  christos 	  relocation
   8378  1.1  christos 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   8379  1.1  christos 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8380  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8381  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8382  1.1  christos 
   8383  1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   8384  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   8385  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
   8386  1.1  christos 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
   8387  1.1  christos 	    {
   8388  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8389  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8390  1.1  christos 	    }
   8391  1.1  christos 	  relocation
   8392  1.1  christos 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   8393  1.1  christos 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8394  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8395  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8396  1.1  christos 
   8397  1.1  christos 	  /* Handle the TOC16 reloc.  We want to use the offset within the .got
   8398  1.1  christos 	     section, not the actual VMA.  This is appropriate when generating
   8399  1.1  christos 	     an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
   8400  1.1  christos 	     AIX .toc section.  */
   8401  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TOC16:			/* phony GOT16 relocations */
   8402  1.6  christos 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8403  1.6  christos 	    {
   8404  1.6  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8405  1.6  christos 	      break;
   8406  1.1  christos 	    }
   8407  1.7  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
   8408  1.1  christos 			      ".got") == 0
   8409  1.1  christos 		      || strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
   8410  1.1  christos 				 ".cgot") == 0);
   8411  1.1  christos 
   8412  1.1  christos 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
   8413  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8414  1.1  christos 
   8415  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   8416  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
   8417  1.1  christos 	    {
   8418  1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8419  1.1  christos 
   8420  1.1  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
   8421  1.1  christos 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8422  1.1  christos 	      if (ent == NULL
   8423  1.7  christos 		  || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
   8424  1.7  christos 		{
   8425  1.1  christos 		  /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
   8426  1.1  christos 		     happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
   8427  1.1  christos 		     using -Bsymbolic.  */
   8428  1.1  christos 		}
   8429  1.1  christos 	      else
   8430  1.1  christos 		{
   8431  1.1  christos 		  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
   8432  1.1  christos 		     procedure linkage table.  */
   8433  1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8434  1.1  christos 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8435  1.8  christos 		    relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8436  1.8  christos 				  + htab->glink->output_offset
   8437  1.8  christos 				  + ent->glink_offset);
   8438  1.8  christos 		  else
   8439  1.8  christos 		    relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8440  1.8  christos 				  + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8441  1.8  christos 				  + ent->plt.offset);
   8442  1.8  christos 		}
   8443  1.8  christos 	    }
   8444  1.8  christos 
   8445  1.8  christos 	  /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   8446  1.8  christos 	     addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
   8447  1.8  christos 	     Don't apply it to the relocation field.  */
   8448  1.8  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8449  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8450  1.8  christos 
   8451  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8452  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8453  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8454  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   8455  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8456  1.8  christos 	  plt_list = NULL;
   8457  1.8  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   8458  1.8  christos 	    plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
   8459  1.8  christos 	  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8460  1.8  christos 	    plt_list = ifunc;
   8461  1.8  christos 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   8462  1.8  christos 	    {
   8463  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   8464  1.8  christos 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   8465  1.8  christos 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   8466  1.8  christos 	      plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
   8467  1.8  christos 	    }
   8468  1.8  christos 	  unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8469  1.8  christos 	  if (plt_list != NULL)
   8470  1.8  christos 	    {
   8471  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8472  1.8  christos 
   8473  1.8  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
   8474  1.8  christos 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8475  1.8  christos 	      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   8476  1.8  christos 		{
   8477  1.8  christos 		  asection *plt;
   8478  1.8  christos 
   8479  1.8  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8480  1.8  christos 		  plt = htab->elf.splt;
   8481  1.8  christos 		  if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   8482  1.8  christos 		      || h == NULL
   8483  1.8  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
   8484  1.8  christos 		    {
   8485  1.8  christos 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8486  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   8487  1.8  christos 		      else
   8488  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   8489  1.8  christos 		    }
   8490  1.8  christos 		  relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
   8491  1.8  christos 				+ plt->output_offset
   8492  1.8  christos 				+ ent->plt.offset);
   8493  1.8  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8494  1.1  christos 		    {
   8495  1.1  christos 		      bfd_vma got = 0;
   8496  1.1  christos 
   8497  1.1  christos 		      if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   8498  1.1  christos 			got = (ent->addend
   8499  1.1  christos 			       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   8500  1.1  christos 			       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   8501  1.1  christos 		      else
   8502  1.1  christos 			got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   8503  1.1  christos 		      relocation -= got;
   8504  1.1  christos 		    }
   8505  1.1  christos 		}
   8506  1.1  christos 	    }
   8507  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8508  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8509  1.1  christos 
   8510  1.3  christos 	  /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_.  */
   8511  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8512  1.1  christos 	  {
   8513  1.8  christos 	    const char *name;
   8514  1.7  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8515  1.8  christos 
   8516  1.8  christos 	    if (sec == NULL
   8517  1.1  christos 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8518  1.1  christos 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8519  1.1  christos 	      {
   8520  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8521  1.1  christos 		break;
   8522  1.1  christos 	      }
   8523  1.1  christos 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8524  1.1  christos 
   8525  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
   8526  1.1  christos 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8527  1.1  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
   8528  1.1  christos 	      {
   8529  1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8530  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8531  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8532  1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8533  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8534  1.1  christos 		   sym_name,
   8535  1.1  christos 		   howto->name,
   8536  1.1  christos 		   name);
   8537  1.1  christos 	      }
   8538  1.1  christos 	  }
   8539  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8540  1.1  christos 
   8541  1.3  christos 	  /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_.  */
   8542  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   8543  1.1  christos 	  {
   8544  1.8  christos 	    const char *name;
   8545  1.7  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8546  1.8  christos 
   8547  1.8  christos 	    if (sec == NULL
   8548  1.1  christos 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8549  1.1  christos 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8550  1.1  christos 	      {
   8551  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8552  1.1  christos 		break;
   8553  1.1  christos 	      }
   8554  1.1  christos 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8555  1.1  christos 
   8556  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
   8557  1.3  christos 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8558  1.7  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
   8559  1.7  christos 	      {
   8560  1.7  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8561  1.6  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8562  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8563  1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8564  1.3  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8565  1.7  christos 		   sym_name,
   8566  1.7  christos 		   howto->name,
   8567  1.7  christos 		   name);
   8568  1.6  christos 	      }
   8569  1.1  christos 	  }
   8570  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8571  1.3  christos 
   8572  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   8573  1.7  christos 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8574  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8575  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8576  1.1  christos 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8577  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8578  1.3  christos 
   8579  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   8580  1.7  christos 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8581  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8582  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8583  1.1  christos 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8584  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8585  1.3  christos 
   8586  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   8587  1.7  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8588  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8589  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8590  1.1  christos 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8591  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8592  1.3  christos 
   8593  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   8594  1.7  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8595  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8596  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8597  1.1  christos 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8598  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8599  1.1  christos 
   8600  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   8601  1.1  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8602  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8603  1.1  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8604  1.1  christos 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8605  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8606  1.3  christos 
   8607  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   8608  1.1  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8609  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8610  1.1  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8611  1.1  christos 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8612  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8613  1.1  christos 
   8614  1.1  christos 	  /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0.  */
   8615  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   8616  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   8617  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   8618  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   8619  1.1  christos 	  {
   8620  1.1  christos 	    const char *name;
   8621  1.1  christos 	    int reg;
   8622  1.3  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   8623  1.3  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8624  1.1  christos 
   8625  1.1  christos 	    if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8626  1.1  christos 	      {
   8627  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8628  1.1  christos 		break;
   8629  1.1  christos 	      }
   8630  1.1  christos 
   8631  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
   8632  1.1  christos 	    if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8633  1.1  christos 		|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8634  1.1  christos 	      {
   8635  1.8  christos 		reg = 13;
   8636  1.7  christos 		sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8637  1.8  christos 	      }
   8638  1.8  christos 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8639  1.1  christos 		     || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8640  1.1  christos 	      {
   8641  1.1  christos 		reg = 2;
   8642  1.1  christos 		sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8643  1.1  christos 	      }
   8644  1.1  christos 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
   8645  1.1  christos 		     || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
   8646  1.6  christos 	      {
   8647  1.1  christos 		reg = 0;
   8648  1.1  christos 	      }
   8649  1.1  christos 	    else
   8650  1.1  christos 	      {
   8651  1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8652  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8653  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8654  1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8655  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8656  1.1  christos 		   sym_name,
   8657  1.1  christos 		   howto->name,
   8658  1.1  christos 		   name);
   8659  1.7  christos 
   8660  1.1  christos 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8661  1.1  christos 		ret = FALSE;
   8662  1.1  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8663  1.1  christos 	      }
   8664  1.3  christos 
   8665  1.3  christos 	    if (sda != NULL)
   8666  1.3  christos 	      {
   8667  1.3  christos 		if (!is_static_defined (sda))
   8668  1.3  christos 		  {
   8669  1.3  christos 		    unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8670  1.3  christos 		    break;
   8671  1.3  christos 		  }
   8672  1.3  christos 		addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8673  1.3  christos 	      }
   8674  1.3  christos 
   8675  1.3  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8676  1.3  christos 	    if (reg == 0
   8677  1.3  christos 		&& (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8678  1.3  christos 		    || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
   8679  1.7  christos 	      {
   8680  1.3  christos 		relocation = relocation + addend;
   8681  1.3  christos 		addend = 0;
   8682  1.3  christos 
   8683  1.3  christos 		/* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn.  */
   8684  1.6  christos 		insn &= 0x1f << 21;
   8685  1.1  christos 		insn |= 28u << 26;
   8686  1.1  christos 
   8687  1.1  christos 		/* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   8688  1.1  christos 		/* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   8689  1.1  christos 		insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   8690  1.3  christos 		/* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   8691  1.1  christos 		insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
   8692  1.1  christos 		/* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   8693  1.7  christos 		insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
   8694  1.1  christos 
   8695  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8696  1.1  christos 
   8697  1.1  christos 		if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8698  1.1  christos 		    && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
   8699  1.1  christos 		  goto overflow;
   8700  1.1  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8701  1.1  christos 	      }
   8702  1.1  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
   8703  1.1  christos 		     || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8704  1.1  christos 		     || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO)
   8705  1.1  christos 	      {
   8706  1.1  christos 		/* Fill in register field.  */
   8707  1.1  christos 		insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
   8708  1.1  christos 	      }
   8709  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8710  1.1  christos 	  }
   8711  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8712  1.1  christos 
   8713  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   8714  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   8715  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   8716  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   8717  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   8718  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   8719  1.3  christos 	  {
   8720  1.7  christos 	    bfd_vma value;
   8721  1.1  christos 	    const char *name;
   8722  1.1  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8723  1.7  christos 
   8724  1.7  christos 	    if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8725  1.8  christos 	      {
   8726  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8727  1.1  christos 		break;
   8728  1.1  christos 	      }
   8729  1.1  christos 
   8730  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
   8731  1.1  christos 	    if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8732  1.1  christos 		|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8733  1.1  christos 	      sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8734  1.6  christos 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8735  1.1  christos 		     || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8736  1.1  christos 	      sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8737  1.7  christos 	    else
   8738  1.1  christos 	      {
   8739  1.7  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8740  1.7  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8741  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8742  1.7  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8743  1.3  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8744  1.3  christos 		   sym_name,
   8745  1.7  christos 		   howto->name,
   8746  1.7  christos 		   name);
   8747  1.7  christos 
   8748  1.7  christos 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8749  1.3  christos 		ret = FALSE;
   8750  1.7  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8751  1.7  christos 	      }
   8752  1.7  christos 
   8753  1.7  christos 	    if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
   8754  1.3  christos 	      {
   8755  1.3  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8756  1.3  christos 		break;
   8757  1.7  christos 	      }
   8758  1.7  christos 	    value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
   8759  1.7  christos 
   8760  1.7  christos 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
   8761  1.3  christos 	      ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8762  1.3  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8763  1.3  christos 				   split16a_type,
   8764  1.3  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8765  1.7  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
   8766  1.7  christos 	      ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8767  1.7  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8768  1.7  christos 				   split16d_type,
   8769  1.3  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8770  1.3  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
   8771  1.3  christos 	      {
   8772  1.3  christos 		value = value >> 16;
   8773  1.7  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8774  1.7  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8775  1.7  christos 				     split16a_type,
   8776  1.7  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8777  1.3  christos 	      }
   8778  1.3  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
   8779  1.3  christos 	      {
   8780  1.3  christos 		value = value >> 16;
   8781  1.7  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8782  1.7  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8783  1.7  christos 				     split16d_type,
   8784  1.7  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8785  1.1  christos 	      }
   8786  1.1  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
   8787  1.6  christos 	      {
   8788  1.1  christos 		value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8789  1.8  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8790  1.8  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8791  1.8  christos 				     split16a_type,
   8792  1.8  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8793  1.1  christos 	      }
   8794  1.1  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
   8795  1.1  christos 	      {
   8796  1.1  christos 		value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8797  1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8798  1.1  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8799  1.1  christos 				     split16d_type,
   8800  1.1  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8801  1.1  christos 	      }
   8802  1.1  christos 	  }
   8803  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8804  1.1  christos 
   8805  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   8806  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
   8807  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   8808  1.1  christos 
   8809  1.1  christos 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
   8810  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8811  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8812  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   8813  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8814  1.1  christos 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8815  1.1  christos 	    {
   8816  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8817  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8818  1.1  christos 	    }
   8819  1.1  christos 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
   8820  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8821  1.1  christos 
   8822  1.1  christos 	  /* Negative relocations.  */
   8823  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   8824  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   8825  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   8826  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   8827  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8828  1.8  christos 	  addend -= 2 * relocation;
   8829  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8830  1.8  christos 
   8831  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   8832  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   8833  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   8834  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   8835  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   8836  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   8837  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   8838  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   8839  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   8840  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   8841  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   8842  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8843  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   8844  1.8  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8845  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   8846  1.8  christos 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
   8847  1.8  christos 
   8848  1.8  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8849  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   8850  1.8  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8851  1.8  christos 	}
   8852  1.8  christos 
   8853  1.8  christos       switch (r_type)
   8854  1.8  christos 	{
   8855  1.8  christos 	default:
   8856  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8857  1.8  christos 
   8858  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8859  1.8  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8860  1.8  christos 	    {
   8861  1.8  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
   8862  1.8  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8863  1.8  christos 	      insn &= 1;
   8864  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
   8865  1.8  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
   8866  1.8  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
   8867  1.8  christos 	      howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8868  1.8  christos 	    }
   8869  1.8  christos 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8870  1.8  christos 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8871  1.8  christos 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8872  1.8  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8873  1.8  christos 	       howto->name);
   8874  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8875  1.8  christos 
   8876  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8877  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8878  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8879  1.1  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8880  1.1  christos 	    {
   8881  1.1  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8882  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8883  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8884  1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   8885  1.1  christos 	      howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8886  1.1  christos 	    }
   8887  1.6  christos 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8888  1.1  christos 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8889  1.1  christos 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8890  1.1  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8891  1.1  christos 	       howto->name);
   8892  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8893  1.1  christos 	}
   8894  1.1  christos 
   8895  1.1  christos       /* Do any further special processing.  */
   8896  1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   8897  1.1  christos 	{
   8898  1.1  christos 	default:
   8899  1.7  christos 	  break;
   8900  1.1  christos 
   8901  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8902  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8903  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8904  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8905  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8906  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8907  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8908  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8909  1.1  christos 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
   8910  1.1  christos 	     that's not actually defined anywhere.  In that case,
   8911  1.1  christos 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
   8912  1.1  christos 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
   8913  1.1  christos 	  if (sec == NULL)
   8914  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8915  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8916  1.1  christos 
   8917  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8918  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   8919  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   8920  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   8921  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   8922  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   8923  1.1  christos 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
   8924  1.1  christos 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
   8925  1.1  christos 	  addend += 0x8000;
   8926  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8927  1.1  christos 
   8928  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8929  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8930  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   8931  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   8932  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8933  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8934  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8935  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   8936  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   8937  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   8938  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8939  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   8940  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   8941  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   8942  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   8943  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   8944  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   8945  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   8946  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   8947  1.6  christos 	  {
   8948  1.6  christos 	    /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
   8949  1.1  christos 	       certain 64-bit instructions.  Prevent damage to bits
   8950  1.1  christos 	       that make up part of the insn opcode.  */
   8951  1.6  christos 	    unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
   8952  1.1  christos 
   8953  1.7  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   8954  1.7  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   8955  1.1  christos 	    mask = 0;
   8956  1.1  christos 	    if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
   8957  1.1  christos 	      mask = 3;
   8958  1.1  christos 	    else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
   8959  1.1  christos 	      mask = 15;
   8960  1.1  christos 	    else
   8961  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8962  1.1  christos 	    relocation += addend;
   8963  1.1  christos 	    addend = insn & mask;
   8964  1.1  christos 	    lobit = mask & relocation;
   8965  1.1  christos 	    if (lobit != 0)
   8966  1.1  christos 	      {
   8967  1.1  christos 		relocation ^= lobit;
   8968  1.1  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   8969  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8970  1.1  christos 		  (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
   8971  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8972  1.1  christos 		   howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
   8973  1.1  christos 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8974  1.1  christos 		ret = FALSE;
   8975  1.1  christos 	      }
   8976  1.1  christos 	  }
   8977  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8978  1.1  christos 	}
   8979  1.1  christos 
   8980  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   8981  1.1  christos       fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
   8982  1.7  christos 	       "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
   8983  1.7  christos 	       howto->name,
   8984  1.1  christos 	       (int) r_type,
   8985  1.1  christos 	       sym_name,
   8986  1.1  christos 	       r_symndx,
   8987  1.1  christos 	       (long) rel->r_offset,
   8988  1.1  christos 	       (long) addend);
   8989  1.1  christos #endif
   8990  1.3  christos 
   8991  1.3  christos       if (unresolved_reloc
   8992  1.3  christos 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
   8993  1.3  christos 	       && h->def_dynamic)
   8994  1.3  christos 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
   8995  1.3  christos 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
   8996  1.3  christos 	{
   8997  1.3  christos 	  info->callbacks->einfo
   8998  1.3  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8999  1.3  christos 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
   9000  1.3  christos 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9001  1.3  christos 	     howto->name,
   9002  1.3  christos 	     sym_name);
   9003  1.3  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   9004  1.3  christos 	}
   9005  1.3  christos 
   9006  1.3  christos       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
   9007  1.3  christos 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
   9008  1.3  christos 	 have different reloc types.  */
   9009  1.3  christos       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
   9010  1.3  christos 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
   9011  1.3  christos 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   9012  1.3  christos 	{
   9013  1.3  christos 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
   9014  1.3  christos 
   9015  1.3  christos 	  if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
   9016  1.3  christos 	    {
   9017  1.3  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   9018  1.3  christos 
   9019  1.6  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
   9020  1.6  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
   9021  1.6  christos 		complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
   9022  1.6  christos 	      else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
   9023  1.6  christos 		       || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
   9024  1.6  christos 		       || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
   9025  1.6  christos 		complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
   9026  1.6  christos 	    }
   9027  1.6  christos 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
   9028  1.6  christos 	    {
   9029  1.6  christos 	      alt_howto = *howto;
   9030  1.6  christos 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
   9031  1.6  christos 	      howto = &alt_howto;
   9032  1.6  christos 	    }
   9033  1.6  christos 	}
   9034  1.6  christos 
   9035  1.6  christos       if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
   9036  1.6  christos 	{
   9037  1.6  christos 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
   9038  1.6  christos 	  if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
   9039  1.6  christos 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   9040  1.6  christos 	  else
   9041  1.6  christos 	    {
   9042  1.6  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   9043  1.1  christos 
   9044  1.1  christos 	      relocation += addend;
   9045  1.1  christos 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
   9046  1.1  christos 			     + input_section->output_offset
   9047  1.1  christos 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
   9048  1.3  christos 	      relocation >>= 16;
   9049  1.5  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   9050  1.5  christos 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
   9051  1.5  christos 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
   9052  1.5  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   9053  1.5  christos 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   9054  1.5  christos 	    }
   9055  1.5  christos 	}
   9056  1.6  christos       else
   9057  1.6  christos 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
   9058  1.6  christos 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
   9059  1.1  christos 
   9060  1.1  christos       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
   9061  1.1  christos 	{
   9062  1.1  christos 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
   9063  1.7  christos 	    {
   9064  1.7  christos 	    overflow:
   9065  1.1  christos 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
   9066  1.1  christos 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
   9067  1.1  christos 	      if (!warned
   9068  1.1  christos 		  && !(h != NULL
   9069  1.1  christos 		       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   9070  1.6  christos 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   9071  1.6  christos 		       && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
   9072  1.6  christos 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
   9073  1.6  christos 		  (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
   9074  1.6  christos 		   rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   9075  1.6  christos 	    }
   9076  1.6  christos 	  else
   9077  1.6  christos 	    {
   9078  1.6  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   9079  1.6  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   9080  1.6  christos 		(_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
   9081  1.6  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9082  1.6  christos 		 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
   9083  1.6  christos 	      ret = FALSE;
   9084  1.6  christos 	    }
   9085  1.6  christos 	}
   9086  1.6  christos     copy_reloc:
   9087  1.6  christos       if (wrel != rel)
   9088  1.6  christos 	*wrel = *rel;
   9089  1.6  christos     }
   9090  1.6  christos 
   9091  1.6  christos   if (wrel != rel)
   9092  1.6  christos     {
   9093  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   9094  1.6  christos       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
   9095  1.1  christos 
   9096  1.1  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
   9097  1.1  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9098  1.1  christos       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
   9099  1.1  christos 	{
   9100  1.1  christos 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
   9101  1.3  christos 	     one NONE reloc.
   9102  1.3  christos 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
   9103  1.3  christos 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   9104  1.3  christos 	  deleted -= 1;
   9105  1.3  christos 	  wrel++;
   9106  1.3  christos 	}
   9107  1.3  christos       relend = wrel;
   9108  1.3  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
   9109  1.3  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9110  1.3  christos       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
   9111  1.3  christos     }
   9112  1.3  christos 
   9113  1.6  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9114  1.3  christos   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9115  1.3  christos #endif
   9116  1.3  christos 
   9117  1.3  christos   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9118  1.3  christos       && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
   9119  1.3  christos       && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   9120  1.3  christos 	  || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
   9121  1.3  christos     {
   9122  1.3  christos       /* Branch around the trampolines.  */
   9123  1.3  christos       unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
   9124  1.3  christos       bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
   9125  1.3  christos     }
   9126  1.3  christos 
   9127  1.3  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   9128  1.3  christos       && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9129  1.3  christos       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   9130  1.3  christos 	  || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
   9131  1.3  christos 	      >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
   9132  1.3  christos     {
   9133  1.3  christos       bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
   9134  1.3  christos       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   9135  1.3  christos 
   9136  1.3  christos       if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
   9137  1.3  christos 	{
   9138  1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte *p;
   9139  1.3  christos 	  unsigned int n;
   9140  1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte fill[4];
   9141  1.3  christos 
   9142  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
   9143  1.3  christos 	  p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
   9144  1.3  christos 	  n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
   9145  1.3  christos 	  while (n--)
   9146  1.3  christos 	    {
   9147  1.3  christos 	      memcpy (p, fill, 4);
   9148  1.3  christos 	      p += 4;
   9149  1.3  christos 	    }
   9150  1.3  christos 	}
   9151  1.3  christos 
   9152  1.3  christos       /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
   9153  1.3  christos 	 branch to a patch area.  Put the insn there followed by a
   9154  1.3  christos 	 branch back to the next page.  Complicated a little by
   9155  1.3  christos 	 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
   9156  1.3  christos 	 wanting to touch data-in-text.  */
   9157  1.3  christos 
   9158  1.3  christos       start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
   9159  1.3  christos 		    + input_section->output_offset);
   9160  1.3  christos       end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9161  1.3  christos 		  - relax_info->workaround_size);
   9162  1.3  christos       for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
   9163  1.3  christos 	   addr < end_addr;
   9164  1.3  christos 	   addr += pagesize)
   9165  1.3  christos 	{
   9166  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
   9167  1.3  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
   9168  1.3  christos 	  bfd_boolean is_data;
   9169  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
   9170  1.3  christos 	  unsigned int insn;
   9171  1.3  christos 
   9172  1.3  christos 	  /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset?  If so, leave
   9173  1.3  christos 	     the word alone.  */
   9174  1.3  christos 	  is_data = FALSE;
   9175  1.3  christos 	  lo = relocs;
   9176  1.3  christos 	  hi = relend;
   9177  1.3  christos 	  rel = NULL;
   9178  1.3  christos 	  while (lo < hi)
   9179  1.3  christos 	    {
   9180  1.3  christos 	      rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
   9181  1.3  christos 	      if (rel->r_offset < offset)
   9182  1.3  christos 		lo = rel + 1;
   9183  1.3  christos 	      else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
   9184  1.3  christos 		hi = rel;
   9185  1.3  christos 	      else
   9186  1.3  christos 		{
   9187  1.3  christos 		  switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   9188  1.3  christos 		    {
   9189  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   9190  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   9191  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_REL32:
   9192  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   9193  1.3  christos 		      is_data = TRUE;
   9194  1.3  christos 		      break;
   9195  1.3  christos 		    default:
   9196  1.3  christos 		      break;
   9197  1.3  christos 		    }
   9198  1.3  christos 		  break;
   9199  1.3  christos 		}
   9200  1.3  christos 	    }
   9201  1.3  christos 	  if (is_data)
   9202  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   9203  1.3  christos 
   9204  1.3  christos 	  /* Some instructions can be left alone too.  Unconditional
   9205  1.3  christos 	     branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
   9206  1.3  christos 	     avoid the icache failure.
   9207  1.3  christos 
   9208  1.3  christos 	     The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
   9209  1.3  christos 	     where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
   9210  1.3  christos 	     page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
   9211  1.3  christos 	     instructions fails under certain circumstances.  The
   9212  1.3  christos 	     unconditional branches:
   9213  1.3  christos 	     1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
   9214  1.3  christos 	     2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
   9215  1.3  christos 	     3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
   9216  1.3  christos 	     where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
   9217  1.3  christos 	     prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
   9218  1.3  christos 	     affected by these instructions.  This happens even if the
   9219  1.3  christos 	     instruction is not executed.
   9220  1.3  christos 
   9221  1.3  christos 	     A bctr example:
   9222  1.3  christos 	     .
   9223  1.6  christos 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha
   9224  1.6  christos 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9225  1.6  christos 	     .	mtctr 9
   9226  1.6  christos 	     .	bctr
   9227  1.3  christos 	     .	nop
   9228  1.6  christos 	     .	nop
   9229  1.6  christos 	     . new_page:
   9230  1.3  christos 	     .
   9231  1.3  christos 	     The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
   9232  1.8  christos 	     ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
   9233  1.8  christos 	     new page which might have stale instructions.  If they
   9234  1.8  christos 	     fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
   9235  1.3  christos 	     bctr executes.  Either of the following modifications
   9236  1.3  christos 	     prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
   9237  1.8  christos 	     place:
   9238  1.3  christos 	     .
   9239  1.3  christos 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha	 lis 9,new_page@ha
   9240  1.3  christos 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l	 addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9241  1.3  christos 	     .	mtctr 9			 mtctr 9
   9242  1.3  christos 	     .	bctr			 bctr
   9243  1.3  christos 	     .	nop			 b somewhere_else
   9244  1.3  christos 	     .	b somewhere_else	 nop
   9245  1.3  christos 	     . new_page:		new_page:
   9246  1.3  christos 	     .  */
   9247  1.3  christos 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
   9248  1.3  christos 	  if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26)	    /* b,bl,ba,bla */
   9249  1.3  christos 	      || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26)	    /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
   9250  1.5  christos 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9251  1.5  christos 	      || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
   9252  1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1)    /* bclr,bclrl */
   9253  1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9254  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   9255  1.3  christos 
   9256  1.3  christos 	  patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9257  1.3  christos 			- relax_info->workaround_size);
   9258  1.3  christos 	  patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
   9259  1.3  christos 	  patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
   9260  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
   9261  1.3  christos 
   9262  1.3  christos 	  if (rel != NULL
   9263  1.3  christos 	      && rel->r_offset >= offset
   9264  1.5  christos 	      && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
   9265  1.5  christos 	    {
   9266  1.5  christos 	      asection *sreloc;
   9267  1.5  christos 
   9268  1.5  christos 	      /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
   9269  1.5  christos 		 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
   9270  1.5  christos 		 location.  This matters for -r and --emit-relocs.  */
   9271  1.5  christos 	      if (rel + 1 != relend)
   9272  1.5  christos 		{
   9273  1.5  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
   9274  1.5  christos 
   9275  1.5  christos 		  /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset.  */
   9276  1.5  christos 		  memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
   9277  1.5  christos 		  relend[-1] = tmp;
   9278  1.5  christos 		}
   9279  1.5  christos 	      relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9280  1.5  christos 
   9281  1.5  christos 	      /* Adjust REL16 addends too.  */
   9282  1.5  christos 	      switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
   9283  1.5  christos 		{
   9284  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16:
   9285  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   9286  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   9287  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   9288  1.5  christos 		  relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
   9289  1.5  christos 		  break;
   9290  1.5  christos 		default:
   9291  1.5  christos 		  break;
   9292  1.5  christos 		}
   9293  1.5  christos 
   9294  1.5  christos 	      /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
   9295  1.5  christos 		 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
   9296  1.5  christos 		 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn.  */
   9297  1.5  christos 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   9298  1.5  christos 	      if (sreloc != NULL)
   9299  1.5  christos 		{
   9300  1.5  christos 		  Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
   9301  1.5  christos 		  bfd_vma soffset;
   9302  1.5  christos 
   9303  1.5  christos 		  slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
   9304  1.5  christos 		  shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
   9305  1.5  christos 		  soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
   9306  1.5  christos 			     + input_section->output_offset);
   9307  1.5  christos 		  while (slo < shi)
   9308  1.5  christos 		    {
   9309  1.5  christos 		      Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
   9310  1.5  christos 		      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
   9311  1.5  christos 						&outrel);
   9312  1.5  christos 		      if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
   9313  1.5  christos 			slo = srel + 1;
   9314  1.5  christos 		      else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
   9315  1.3  christos 			shi = srel;
   9316  1.3  christos 		      else
   9317  1.3  christos 			{
   9318  1.3  christos 			  if (srel + 1 != srelend)
   9319  1.3  christos 			    {
   9320  1.3  christos 			      memmove (srel, srel + 1,
   9321  1.3  christos 				       (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
   9322  1.3  christos 			      srel = srelend - 1;
   9323  1.3  christos 			    }
   9324  1.3  christos 			  outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9325  1.6  christos 			  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
   9326  1.3  christos 						     (bfd_byte *) srel);
   9327  1.6  christos 			  break;
   9328  1.3  christos 			}
   9329  1.3  christos 		    }
   9330  1.3  christos 		}
   9331  1.3  christos 	    }
   9332  1.3  christos 	  else
   9333  1.3  christos 	    rel = NULL;
   9334  1.3  christos 
   9335  1.3  christos 	  if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
   9336  1.3  christos 	      && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
   9337  1.3  christos 	    {
   9338  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
   9339  1.3  christos 
   9340  1.3  christos 	      delta += offset - patch_off;
   9341  1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9342  1.3  christos 		delta = 0;
   9343  1.3  christos 	      if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9344  1.3  christos 		{
   9345  1.3  christos 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   9346  1.3  christos 
   9347  1.3  christos 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
   9348  1.3  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
   9349  1.3  christos 		    insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9350  1.3  christos 		  else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9351  1.3  christos 		    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9352  1.3  christos 		  else
   9353  1.3  christos 		    BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
   9354  1.3  christos 
   9355  1.3  christos 		  if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   9356  1.3  christos 		       || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9357  1.3  christos 		      && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   9358  1.3  christos 		      && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
   9359  1.3  christos 		    insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9360  1.3  christos 		}
   9361  1.3  christos 	      if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   9362  1.3  christos 		{
   9363  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9364  1.3  christos 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
   9365  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9366  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9367  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9368  1.3  christos 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9369  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9370  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9371  1.3  christos 		}
   9372  1.3  christos 	      else
   9373  1.3  christos 		{
   9374  1.3  christos 		  if (rel != NULL)
   9375  1.3  christos 		    {
   9376  1.3  christos 		      unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
   9377  1.3  christos 
   9378  1.3  christos 		      relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
   9379  1.3  christos 		      relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
   9380  1.3  christos 		    }
   9381  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9382  1.3  christos 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
   9383  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9384  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9385  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9386  1.3  christos 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9387  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9388  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9389  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9390  1.3  christos 			      B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
   9391  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9392  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9393  1.1  christos 		}
   9394  1.1  christos 	    }
   9395  1.1  christos 	  else
   9396  1.8  christos 	    {
   9397  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
   9398  1.1  christos 	      patch_off += 4;
   9399  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9400  1.1  christos 			  B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9401  1.8  christos 			  contents + patch_off);
   9402  1.8  christos 	      patch_off += 4;
   9403  1.1  christos 	    }
   9404  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
   9405  1.1  christos 	  relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
   9406  1.1  christos 	}
   9407  1.1  christos     }
   9408  1.1  christos 
   9409  1.1  christos   return ret;
   9410  1.1  christos }
   9411  1.1  christos 
   9412  1.1  christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H.  */
   9414  1.1  christos 
   9415  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   9416  1.8  christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   9417  1.1  christos {
   9418  1.1  christos   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
   9419  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9420  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9421  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean doneone;
   9422  1.1  christos 
   9423  1.1  christos   doneone = FALSE;
   9424  1.1  christos   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9425  1.1  christos     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9426  1.1  christos       {
   9427  1.1  christos 	if (!doneone)
   9428  1.1  christos 	  {
   9429  1.1  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9430  1.1  christos 	    bfd_byte *loc;
   9431  1.1  christos 	    bfd_vma reloc_index;
   9432  1.1  christos 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9433  1.1  christos 	    asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
   9434  1.1  christos 
   9435  1.1  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   9436  1.1  christos 		|| !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9437  1.1  christos 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
   9438  1.1  christos 	      reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
   9439  1.1  christos 	    else
   9440  1.1  christos 	      {
   9441  1.1  christos 		reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   9442  1.1  christos 			       / htab->plt_slot_size);
   9443  1.1  christos 		if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
   9444  1.6  christos 		    && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   9445  1.1  christos 		  reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
   9446  1.1  christos 	      }
   9447  1.1  christos 
   9448  1.6  christos 	    /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
   9449  1.1  christos 	       Set it up.  */
   9450  1.8  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
   9451  1.1  christos 		&& htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9452  1.8  christos 		&& h->dynindx != -1)
   9453  1.8  christos 	      {
   9454  1.1  christos 		bfd_vma got_offset;
   9455  1.8  christos 		const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
   9456  1.1  christos 
   9457  1.1  christos 		/* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved.  */
   9458  1.1  christos 		got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
   9459  1.1  christos 
   9460  1.1  christos 		/* Use the right PLT. */
   9461  1.8  christos 		plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
   9462  1.1  christos 			    : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
   9463  1.8  christos 
   9464  1.8  christos 		/* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks.  */
   9465  1.1  christos 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9466  1.8  christos 		  {
   9467  1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9468  1.1  christos 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
   9469  1.8  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9470  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9471  1.8  christos 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
   9472  1.8  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9473  1.1  christos 		  }
   9474  1.1  christos 		else
   9475  1.1  christos 		  {
   9476  1.1  christos 		    bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9477  1.1  christos 
   9478  1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9479  1.1  christos 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
   9480  1.8  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9481  1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9482  1.8  christos 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
   9483  1.1  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9484  1.1  christos 		  }
   9485  1.1  christos 
   9486  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
   9487  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
   9488  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
   9489  1.8  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
   9490  1.1  christos 
   9491  1.1  christos 		/* This instruction is an immediate load.  The value loaded is
   9492  1.8  christos 		   the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
   9493  1.8  christos 		   start of the .rela.plt section.  The value is stored in the
   9494  1.8  christos 		   low-order 16 bits of the load instruction.  */
   9495  1.8  christos 		/* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
   9496  1.8  christos 		   prescaled offset.  */
   9497  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9498  1.1  christos 			    plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
   9499  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
   9500  1.1  christos 		/* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
   9501  1.8  christos 		   the start of the PLT section.  The address of this branch
   9502  1.8  christos 		   instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
   9503  1.8  christos 		   The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive.  The value
   9504  1.7  christos 		   stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
   9505  1.1  christos 		   offset.  */
   9506  1.6  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9507  1.1  christos 			    (plt_entry[5]
   9508  1.1  christos 			     | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
   9509  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
   9510  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
   9511  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
   9512  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
   9513  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
   9514  1.1  christos 
   9515  1.8  christos 		/* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
   9516  1.8  christos 		   the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
   9517  1.1  christos 		   in this PLT entry.  */
   9518  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
   9519  1.1  christos 					       + plt->output_offset
   9520  1.1  christos 					       + ent->plt.offset + 16),
   9521  1.8  christos 			    htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
   9522  1.1  christos 
   9523  1.1  christos 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9524  1.1  christos 		  {
   9525  1.8  christos 		    /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
   9526  1.8  christos 		    loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
   9527  1.1  christos 		      + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
   9528  1.1  christos 			  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
   9529  1.1  christos 			 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9530  1.1  christos 
   9531  1.8  christos 		    /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   9532  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9533  1.1  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9534  1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset + 2);
   9535  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9536  1.7  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   9537  1.7  christos 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9538  1.1  christos 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9539  1.1  christos 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9540  1.1  christos 
   9541  1.1  christos 		    /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   9542  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9543  1.1  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9544  1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset + 6);
   9545  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9546  1.1  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   9547  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9548  1.1  christos 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9549  1.1  christos 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9550  1.7  christos 
   9551  1.7  christos 		    /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
   9552  1.1  christos 		       PLT slot.  Point it at the middle of the .plt entry.  */
   9553  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9554  1.1  christos 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9555  1.1  christos 				     + got_offset);
   9556  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
   9557  1.8  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR32);
   9558  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
   9559  1.1  christos 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9560  1.8  christos 		  }
   9561  1.8  christos 
   9562  1.8  christos 		/* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
   9563  1.8  christos 		   In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
   9564  1.8  christos 		   address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
   9565  1.8  christos 		   by the ABI.  Instead, the offset is set to the address of
   9566  1.8  christos 		   the GOT slot for this function.  See EABI 4.4.4.1.  */
   9567  1.8  christos 		rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9568  1.8  christos 				 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9569  1.8  christos 				 + got_offset);
   9570  1.8  christos 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9571  1.8  christos 	      }
   9572  1.8  christos 	    else
   9573  1.8  christos 	      {
   9574  1.8  christos 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9575  1.8  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9576  1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1)
   9577  1.8  christos 		  {
   9578  1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9579  1.8  christos 		      {
   9580  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9581  1.1  christos 			relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9582  1.1  christos 		      }
   9583  1.1  christos 		    else
   9584  1.8  christos 		      {
   9585  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9586  1.8  christos 			relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
   9587  1.8  christos 		      }
   9588  1.8  christos 		    if (h->def_regular
   9589  1.8  christos 			&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   9590  1.8  christos 			    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   9591  1.8  christos 		      rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
   9592  1.8  christos 		  }
   9593  1.8  christos 
   9594  1.8  christos 		if (relplt == NULL)
   9595  1.8  christos 		  {
   9596  1.8  christos 		    loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9597  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
   9598  1.8  christos 		  }
   9599  1.8  christos 		else
   9600  1.8  christos 		  {
   9601  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9602  1.8  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9603  1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset);
   9604  1.1  christos 
   9605  1.1  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
   9606  1.8  christos 			|| !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9607  1.1  christos 			|| h->dynindx == -1)
   9608  1.8  christos 		      {
   9609  1.8  christos 			/* We don't need to fill in the .plt.  The ppc dynamic
   9610  1.8  christos 			   linker will fill it in.  */
   9611  1.8  christos 		      }
   9612  1.8  christos 		    else
   9613  1.8  christos 		      {
   9614  1.8  christos 			bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
   9615  1.8  christos 				       + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   9616  1.8  christos 				       + htab->glink->output_offset);
   9617  1.8  christos 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
   9618  1.8  christos 				    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
   9619  1.8  christos 		      }
   9620  1.8  christos 		  }
   9621  1.1  christos 	      }
   9622  1.8  christos 
   9623  1.8  christos 	    if (relplt != NULL)
   9624  1.8  christos 	      {
   9625  1.8  christos 		/* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   9626  1.8  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9627  1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1)
   9628  1.8  christos 		  {
   9629  1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9630  1.1  christos 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9631  1.1  christos 		    else
   9632  1.1  christos 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9633  1.1  christos 		    loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
   9634  1.1  christos 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9635  1.1  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9636  1.1  christos 		  }
   9637  1.1  christos 		else
   9638  1.8  christos 		  {
   9639  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
   9640  1.1  christos 		    loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
   9641  1.1  christos 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9642  1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
   9643  1.8  christos 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9644  1.8  christos 		  }
   9645  1.8  christos 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9646  1.8  christos 	      }
   9647  1.1  christos 	    doneone = TRUE;
   9648  1.1  christos 	  }
   9649  1.8  christos 
   9650  1.8  christos 	if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   9651  1.1  christos 	    || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9652  1.6  christos 	    || h->dynindx == -1)
   9653  1.1  christos 	  {
   9654  1.1  christos 	    unsigned char *p;
   9655  1.1  christos 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9656  1.1  christos 
   9657  1.1  christos 	    if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9658  1.1  christos 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
   9659  1.8  christos 	      {
   9660  1.8  christos 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9661  1.8  christos 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9662  1.8  christos 		else
   9663  1.8  christos 		  break;
   9664  1.8  christos 	      }
   9665  1.8  christos 
   9666  1.8  christos 	    p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9667  1.8  christos 	    write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
   9668  1.8  christos 
   9669  1.8  christos 	    if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9670  1.8  christos 	      /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub.  */
   9671  1.8  christos 	      break;
   9672  1.8  christos 	  }
   9673  1.8  christos 	else
   9674  1.8  christos 	  break;
   9675  1.8  christos       }
   9676  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   9677  1.8  christos }
   9678  1.8  christos 
   9679  1.8  christos /* Finish up PLT handling.  */
   9680  1.8  christos 
   9681  1.8  christos bfd_boolean
   9682  1.8  christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9683  1.8  christos {
   9684  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9685  1.8  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   9686  1.8  christos 
   9687  1.8  christos   if (!htab)
   9688  1.8  christos     return TRUE;
   9689  1.8  christos 
   9690  1.8  christos   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
   9691  1.8  christos 
   9692  1.8  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   9693  1.8  christos     {
   9694  1.8  christos       bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
   9695  1.8  christos       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
   9696  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   9697  1.8  christos       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   9698  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
   9699  1.8  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   9700  1.8  christos 
   9701  1.8  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   9702  1.8  christos 	continue;
   9703  1.8  christos 
   9704  1.8  christos       local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
   9705  1.8  christos       if (!local_got)
   9706  1.8  christos 	continue;
   9707  1.8  christos 
   9708  1.8  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   9709  1.8  christos       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   9710  1.8  christos       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   9711  1.8  christos       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   9712  1.8  christos       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   9713  1.8  christos       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
   9714  1.8  christos 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9715  1.8  christos 	  {
   9716  1.8  christos 	    if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9717  1.8  christos 	      {
   9718  1.8  christos 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   9719  1.8  christos 		asection *sym_sec;
   9720  1.8  christos 		asection *plt, *relplt;
   9721  1.8  christos 		bfd_byte *loc;
   9722  1.8  christos 		bfd_vma val;
   9723  1.8  christos 		Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9724  1.8  christos 
   9725  1.8  christos 		if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
   9726  1.8  christos 				lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
   9727  1.8  christos 		  {
   9728  1.8  christos 		    if (local_syms != NULL
   9729  1.8  christos 			&& symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9730  1.8  christos 		      free (local_syms);
   9731  1.8  christos 		    return FALSE;
   9732  1.8  christos 		  }
   9733  1.8  christos 
   9734  1.8  christos 		val = sym->st_value;
   9735  1.8  christos 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   9736  1.8  christos 		  val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
   9737  1.8  christos 
   9738  1.8  christos 		if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9739  1.8  christos 		  {
   9740  1.8  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9741  1.8  christos 		    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9742  1.8  christos 		    relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9743  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9744  1.8  christos 		  }
   9745  1.8  christos 		else
   9746  1.8  christos 		  {
   9747  1.8  christos 		    plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9748  1.8  christos 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9749  1.8  christos 		      {
   9750  1.8  christos 			relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
   9751  1.8  christos 			rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9752  1.8  christos 		      }
   9753  1.8  christos 		    else
   9754  1.8  christos 		      {
   9755  1.8  christos 			loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9756  1.8  christos 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
   9757  1.8  christos 			continue;
   9758  1.8  christos 		      }
   9759  1.8  christos 		  }
   9760  1.8  christos 
   9761  1.8  christos 		rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
   9762  1.8  christos 				 + plt->output_offset
   9763  1.8  christos 				 + plt->output_section->vma);
   9764  1.8  christos 		rela.r_addend = val;
   9765  1.8  christos 		loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
   9766  1.8  christos 					  * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9767  1.8  christos 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9768  1.8  christos 	      }
   9769  1.8  christos 	    if ((ent->glink_offset & 1) == 0)
   9770  1.8  christos 	      {
   9771  1.8  christos 		unsigned char *p = ((unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents
   9772  1.8  christos 				    + ent->glink_offset);
   9773  1.8  christos 
   9774  1.8  christos 		write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
   9775  1.8  christos 		ent->glink_offset |= 1;
   9776  1.8  christos 	      }
   9777  1.8  christos 	  }
   9778  1.8  christos 
   9779  1.8  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   9780  1.8  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9781  1.8  christos 	{
   9782  1.8  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   9783  1.8  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   9784  1.8  christos 	  else
   9785  1.8  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   9786  1.8  christos 	}
   9787  1.8  christos     }
   9788  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   9789  1.8  christos }
   9790  1.8  christos 
   9791  1.8  christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
   9792  1.8  christos    dynamic sections here.  */
   9793  1.8  christos 
   9794  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   9795  1.8  christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
   9796  1.8  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9797  1.8  christos 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   9798  1.8  christos 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   9799  1.8  christos {
   9800  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9801  1.8  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9802  1.8  christos 
   9803  1.8  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9804  1.8  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
   9805  1.8  christos 	   h->root.root.string);
   9806  1.8  christos #endif
   9807  1.8  christos 
   9808  1.8  christos   if (!h->def_regular
   9809  1.8  christos       || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
   9810  1.8  christos     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9811  1.8  christos       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9812  1.8  christos 	{
   9813  1.8  christos 	  if (!h->def_regular)
   9814  1.8  christos 	    {
   9815  1.8  christos 	      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
   9816  1.8  christos 		 defined in the .plt section.  Leave the value if
   9817  1.8  christos 		 there were any relocations where pointer equality
   9818  1.8  christos 		 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
   9819  1.8  christos 		 make function pointer comparisons work between an
   9820  1.8  christos 		 application and shared library), otherwise set it
   9821  1.8  christos 		 to zero.  */
   9822  1.8  christos 	      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   9823  1.8  christos 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
   9824  1.8  christos 		sym->st_value = 0;
   9825  1.8  christos 	      else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
   9826  1.8  christos 		{
   9827  1.8  christos 		  /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
   9828  1.8  christos 		     that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
   9829  1.8  christos 		     function pointer.  */
   9830  1.8  christos 		  sym->st_value = 0;
   9831  1.8  christos 		}
   9832  1.8  christos 	    }
   9833  1.8  christos 	  else
   9834  1.1  christos 	    {
   9835  1.1  christos 	      /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
   9836  1.1  christos 		 executable to the glink entry.  This is to avoid
   9837  1.1  christos 		 text relocations.  We can't do this for ifunc in
   9838  1.1  christos 		 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
   9839  1.1  christos 		 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
   9840  1.1  christos 		 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
   9841  1.1  christos 		 relocation.  */
   9842  1.1  christos 	      sym->st_shndx
   9843  1.1  christos 		= (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   9844  1.1  christos 		   (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
   9845  1.1  christos 	      sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
   9846  1.1  christos 			       + htab->glink->output_offset
   9847  1.1  christos 			       + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
   9848  1.1  christos 	    }
   9849  1.1  christos 	  break;
   9850  1.1  christos 	}
   9851  1.7  christos 
   9852  1.7  christos   if (h->needs_copy)
   9853  1.1  christos     {
   9854  1.7  christos       asection *s;
   9855  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9856  1.1  christos       bfd_byte *loc;
   9857  1.1  christos 
   9858  1.1  christos       /* This symbols needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
   9859  1.1  christos 
   9860  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9861  1.1  christos       fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
   9862  1.1  christos #endif
   9863  1.1  christos 
   9864  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
   9865  1.1  christos 
   9866  1.1  christos       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   9867  1.1  christos 	s = htab->relsbss;
   9868  1.1  christos       else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
   9869  1.1  christos 	s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   9870  1.1  christos       else
   9871  1.1  christos 	s = htab->elf.srelbss;
   9872  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   9873  1.1  christos 
   9874  1.1  christos       rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
   9875  1.1  christos       rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
   9876  1.1  christos       rela.r_addend = 0;
   9877  1.1  christos       loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9878  1.7  christos       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9879  1.1  christos     }
   9880  1.1  christos 
   9881  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9882  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9883  1.1  christos #endif
   9884  1.1  christos 
   9885  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   9886  1.1  christos }
   9887  1.1  christos 
   9888  1.1  christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
   9890  1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9891  1.1  christos 			  const asection *rel_sec,
   9892  1.1  christos 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
   9893  1.1  christos {
   9894  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9895  1.1  christos 
   9896  1.1  christos   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
   9897  1.1  christos     return reloc_class_ifunc;
   9898  1.1  christos 
   9899  1.1  christos   switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
   9900  1.1  christos     {
   9901  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   9902  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_relative;
   9903  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   9904  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_plt;
   9905  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_COPY:
   9906  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_copy;
   9907  1.1  christos     default:
   9908  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_normal;
   9909  1.1  christos     }
   9910  1.1  christos }
   9911  1.7  christos 
   9912  1.1  christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
   9914  1.1  christos 
   9915  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   9916  1.1  christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   9917  1.1  christos 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9918  1.1  christos {
   9919  1.1  christos   asection *sdyn;
   9920  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   9921  1.1  christos   bfd_vma got;
   9922  1.7  christos   bfd *dynobj;
   9923  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   9924  1.1  christos 
   9925  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9926  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
   9927  1.1  christos #endif
   9928  1.1  christos 
   9929  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9930  1.1  christos   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
   9931  1.1  christos   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
   9932  1.1  christos 
   9933  1.1  christos   got = 0;
   9934  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   9935  1.1  christos     got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9936  1.1  christos 
   9937  1.7  christos   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   9938  1.1  christos     {
   9939  1.7  christos       Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
   9940  1.1  christos 
   9941  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
   9942  1.1  christos 
   9943  1.1  christos       dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
   9944  1.7  christos       dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
   9945  1.1  christos       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
   9946  1.1  christos 	{
   9947  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   9948  1.7  christos 	  asection *s;
   9949  1.1  christos 
   9950  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
   9951  1.1  christos 
   9952  1.1  christos 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   9953  1.1  christos 	    {
   9954  1.1  christos 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
   9955  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->is_vxworks)
   9956  1.7  christos 		s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
   9957  1.7  christos 	      else
   9958  1.7  christos 		s = htab->elf.splt;
   9959  1.7  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   9960  1.7  christos 	      break;
   9961  1.7  christos 
   9962  1.7  christos 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
   9963  1.7  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
   9964  1.7  christos 	      break;
   9965  1.1  christos 
   9966  1.1  christos 	    case DT_JMPREL:
   9967  1.1  christos 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
   9968  1.1  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   9969  1.1  christos 	      break;
   9970  1.1  christos 
   9971  1.1  christos 	    case DT_PPC_GOT:
   9972  1.1  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
   9973  1.1  christos 	      break;
   9974  1.1  christos 
   9975  1.1  christos 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
   9976  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
   9977  1.1  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   9978  1.7  christos 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   9979  1.7  christos 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   9980  1.1  christos 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
   9981  1.7  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   9982  1.7  christos 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   9983  1.1  christos 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   9984  1.1  christos 	      continue;
   9985  1.1  christos 
   9986  1.1  christos 	    default:
   9987  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->is_vxworks
   9988  1.1  christos 		  && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
   9989  1.1  christos 		break;
   9990  1.1  christos 	      continue;
   9991  1.1  christos 	    }
   9992  1.1  christos 
   9993  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
   9994  1.1  christos 	}
   9995  1.1  christos     }
   9996  1.1  christos 
   9997  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   9998  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   9999  1.1  christos     {
   10000  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
   10001  1.1  christos 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
   10002  1.1  christos 	{
   10003  1.1  christos 	  unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
   10004  1.1  christos 
   10005  1.1  christos 	  p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   10006  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   10007  1.7  christos 	    {
   10008  1.8  christos 	      /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
   10009  1.8  christos 		 so that a function can easily find the address of
   10010  1.8  christos 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
   10011  1.8  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
   10012  1.1  christos 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   10013  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
   10014  1.1  christos 	    }
   10015  1.1  christos 
   10016  1.7  christos 	  if (sdyn != NULL)
   10017  1.1  christos 	    {
   10018  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
   10019  1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
   10020  1.7  christos 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   10021  1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
   10022  1.7  christos 	    }
   10023  1.7  christos 	}
   10024  1.1  christos       else
   10025  1.7  christos 	{
   10026  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   10027  1.6  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
   10028  1.1  christos 			      htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
   10029  1.1  christos 			      (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
   10030  1.1  christos 			       ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
   10031  1.6  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   10032  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   10033  1.1  christos 	}
   10034  1.1  christos 
   10035  1.1  christos       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
   10036  1.1  christos     }
   10037  1.1  christos 
   10038  1.1  christos   /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table.  */
   10039  1.1  christos   if (htab->is_vxworks
   10040  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   10041  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
   10042  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   10043  1.1  christos     {
   10044  1.1  christos       asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
   10045  1.1  christos       /* Use the right PLT. */
   10046  1.1  christos       const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
   10047  1.1  christos 				  ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
   10048  1.1  christos 				  : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
   10049  1.1  christos 
   10050  1.1  christos       if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   10051  1.1  christos 	{
   10052  1.6  christos 	  bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   10053  1.1  christos 
   10054  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
   10055  1.1  christos 		      splt->contents +  0);
   10056  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
   10057  1.1  christos 		      splt->contents +  4);
   10058  1.1  christos 	}
   10059  1.1  christos       else
   10060  1.7  christos 	{
   10061  1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents +  0);
   10062  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents +  4);
   10063  1.1  christos 	}
   10064  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents +  8);
   10065  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
   10066  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
   10067  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
   10068  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
   10069  1.7  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
   10070  1.7  christos 
   10071  1.1  christos       if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   10072  1.1  christos 	{
   10073  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   10074  1.1  christos 	  bfd_byte *loc;
   10075  1.1  christos 
   10076  1.1  christos 	  loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
   10077  1.1  christos 
   10078  1.1  christos 	  /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   10079  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10080  1.1  christos 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10081  1.1  christos 			   + 2);
   10082  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10083  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10084  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   10085  1.1  christos 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10086  1.1  christos 
   10087  1.1  christos 	  /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   10088  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10089  1.1  christos 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10090  1.1  christos 			   + 6);
   10091  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10092  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10093  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   10094  1.1  christos 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10095  1.1  christos 
   10096  1.1  christos 	  /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
   10097  1.1  christos 	     symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
   10098  1.1  christos 	     in which symbols were output.  */
   10099  1.1  christos 	  while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
   10100  1.1  christos 	    {
   10101  1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
   10102  1.1  christos 
   10103  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10104  1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10105  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10106  1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10107  1.1  christos 
   10108  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10109  1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10110  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10111  1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10112  1.1  christos 
   10113  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10114  1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
   10115  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10116  1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10117  1.1  christos 	    }
   10118  1.1  christos 	}
   10119  1.1  christos     }
   10120  1.1  christos 
   10121  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   10122  1.1  christos       && htab->glink->contents != NULL
   10123  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   10124  1.1  christos     {
   10125  1.1  christos       unsigned char *p;
   10126  1.1  christos       unsigned char *endp;
   10127  1.1  christos       bfd_vma res0;
   10128  1.1  christos 
   10129  1.1  christos       /*
   10130  1.1  christos        * PIC glink code is the following:
   10131  1.1  christos        *
   10132  1.1  christos        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10133  1.1  christos        *   addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
   10134  1.1  christos        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
   10135  1.1  christos        *   mtctr 11
   10136  1.1  christos        *   bctr
   10137  1.8  christos        *
   10138  1.1  christos        * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
   10139  1.8  christos        * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
   10140  1.8  christos        * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
   10141  1.1  christos        * res_0:	b PLTresolve
   10142  1.1  christos        * res_1:	b PLTresolve
   10143  1.8  christos        * .
   10144  1.1  christos        * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
   10145  1.8  christos        * res_n_m3: nop
   10146  1.1  christos        * res_n_m2: nop
   10147  1.1  christos        * res_n_m1:
   10148  1.1  christos        *
   10149  1.1  christos        * PLTresolve:
   10150  1.1  christos        *    addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
   10151  1.1  christos        *    mflr 0
   10152  1.1  christos        *    bcl 20,31,1f
   10153  1.1  christos        * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
   10154  1.1  christos        *    mflr 12
   10155  1.1  christos        *    mtlr 0
   10156  1.1  christos        *    sub 11,11,12		# r11 = index * 4
   10157  1.1  christos        *    addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
   10158  1.1  christos        *    lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12)	# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10159  1.8  christos        *    lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10160  1.8  christos        *    mtctr 0
   10161  1.1  christos        *    add 0,11,11
   10162  1.1  christos        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10163  1.8  christos        *    bctr
   10164  1.8  christos        *
   10165  1.1  christos        * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
   10166  1.1  christos        *
   10167  1.1  christos        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10168  1.1  christos        *   lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
   10169  1.1  christos        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
   10170  1.1  christos        *   mtctr 11
   10171  1.1  christos        *   bctr
   10172  1.1  christos        *
   10173  1.1  christos        * The branch table is the same, then comes
   10174  1.3  christos        *
   10175  1.1  christos        * PLTresolve:
   10176  1.1  christos        *    lis 12,(got+4)@ha
   10177  1.1  christos        *    addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
   10178  1.1  christos        *    lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12)		# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10179  1.1  christos        *    addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l	# r11 = index * 4
   10180  1.1  christos        *    mtctr 0
   10181  1.1  christos        *    add 0,11,11
   10182  1.1  christos        *    lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10183  1.1  christos        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10184  1.1  christos        *    bctr
   10185  1.1  christos        */
   10186  1.1  christos 
   10187  1.1  christos       /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
   10188  1.1  christos 	 and perhaps some padding.  */
   10189  1.3  christos       p = htab->glink->contents;
   10190  1.3  christos       p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
   10191  1.3  christos       endp = htab->glink->contents;
   10192  1.3  christos       endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10193  1.3  christos       while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
   10194  1.3  christos 	{
   10195  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
   10196  1.3  christos 	  p += 4;
   10197  1.3  christos 	}
   10198  1.3  christos       while (p < endp)
   10199  1.3  christos 	{
   10200  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   10201  1.3  christos 	  p += 4;
   10202  1.3  christos 	}
   10203  1.3  christos 
   10204  1.3  christos       res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
   10205  1.3  christos 	      + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10206  1.3  christos 	      + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10207  1.3  christos 
   10208  1.3  christos       if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
   10209  1.3  christos 	{
   10210  1.3  christos 	  /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
   10211  1.3  christos 	     result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
   10212  1.3  christos 	     glink branch table.  */
   10213  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   10214  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma page_addr;
   10215  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10216  1.3  christos 				 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10217  1.3  christos 
   10218  1.3  christos 	  for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
   10219  1.3  christos 	       page_addr > glink_start;
   10220  1.3  christos 	       page_addr -= pagesize)
   10221  1.3  christos 	    {
   10222  1.1  christos 	      /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing.  */
   10223  1.8  christos 	      bfd_byte *loc;
   10224  1.6  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   10225  1.1  christos 
   10226  1.1  christos 	      loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
   10227  1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   10228  1.1  christos 	      if (insn == BCTR)
   10229  1.1  christos 		{
   10230  1.1  christos 		  /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
   10231  1.1  christos 		     one other call stub before this one.  */
   10232  1.8  christos 		  insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
   10233  1.8  christos 		  if (insn == BCTR)
   10234  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10235  1.8  christos 		  else
   10236  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10237  1.8  christos 		}
   10238  1.8  christos 	    }
   10239  1.8  christos 	}
   10240  1.8  christos 
   10241  1.8  christos       /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub.  */
   10242  1.8  christos       endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10243  1.8  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   10244  1.8  christos 	{
   10245  1.8  christos 	  bfd_vma bcl;
   10246  1.8  christos 
   10247  1.8  christos 	  bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
   10248  1.1  christos 		 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10249  1.1  christos 		 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10250  1.8  christos 
   10251  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
   10252  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10253  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
   10254  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10255  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
   10256  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10257  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
   10258  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10259  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
   10260  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10261  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
   10262  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10263  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
   10264  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10265  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10266  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10267  1.1  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
   10268  1.8  christos 	    {
   10269  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10270  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10271  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
   10272  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10273  1.8  christos 	    }
   10274  1.8  christos 	  else
   10275  1.8  christos 	    {
   10276  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10277  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10278  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10279  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10280  1.8  christos 	    }
   10281  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10282  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10283  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10284  1.8  christos 	}
   10285  1.1  christos       else
   10286  1.8  christos 	{
   10287  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
   10288  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10289  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
   10290  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10291  1.8  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10292  1.8  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10293  1.8  christos 	  else
   10294  1.8  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10295  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10296  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
   10297  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10298  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10299  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10300  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10301  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10302  1.1  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10303  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
   10304  1.1  christos 	  else
   10305  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10306  1.1  christos 	}
   10307  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10308  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
   10309  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10310  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   10311  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10312  1.1  christos       while (p < endp)
   10313  1.1  christos 	{
   10314  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
   10315  1.1  christos 		      htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   10316  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10317  1.1  christos 	}
   10318  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
   10319  1.1  christos     }
   10320  1.1  christos 
   10321  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   10322  1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   10323  1.1  christos     {
   10324  1.1  christos       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10325  1.1  christos       bfd_vma val;
   10326  1.1  christos 
   10327  1.1  christos       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   10328  1.1  christos       /* FDE length.  */
   10329  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10330  1.1  christos       /* CIE pointer.  */
   10331  1.3  christos       p += 4;
   10332  1.1  christos       /* Offset to .glink.  */
   10333  1.3  christos       val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10334  1.1  christos 	     + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10335  1.1  christos       val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
   10336  1.1  christos 	      + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
   10337  1.1  christos       val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10338  1.8  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   10339  1.3  christos 
   10340  1.8  christos       if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
   10341  1.1  christos 	  && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
   10342  1.1  christos 					       htab->glink_eh_frame,
   10343  1.1  christos 					       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
   10344  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   10345  1.1  christos     }
   10346  1.1  christos 
   10347  1.1  christos   return ret;
   10348  1.1  christos }
   10349  1.1  christos 
   10350  1.1  christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf32_le_vec
   10352  1.7  christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf32-powerpcle"
   10353  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vec
   10354  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc"
   10355  1.1  christos #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
   10356  1.3  christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC32_ELF_DATA
   10357  1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC
   10358  1.1  christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
   10359  1.1  christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
   10360  1.1  christos #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE	ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
   10361  1.1  christos #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc_elf_info_to_howto
   10362  1.1  christos 
   10363  1.1  christos #ifdef  EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10364  1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1	EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10365  1.1  christos #endif
   10366  1.1  christos 
   10367  1.1  christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
   10368  1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2	EM_PPC_OLD
   10369  1.1  christos #endif
   10370  1.1  christos 
   10371  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded	1
   10372  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro	1
   10373  1.8  christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	1
   10374  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount	1
   10375  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal		1
   10376  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	1
   10377  1.1  christos 
   10378  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject			ppc_elf_mkobject
   10379  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data	ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
   10380  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section		ppc_elf_relax_section
   10381  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
   10382  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
   10383  1.8  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags		ppc_elf_set_private_flags
   10384  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create	ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
   10385  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab		ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
   10386  1.1  christos 
   10387  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_object_p			ppc_elf_object_p
   10388  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook		ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
   10389  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr		ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
   10390  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section		ppc_elf_relocate_section
   10391  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
   10392  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs		ppc_elf_check_relocs
   10393  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible		_bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
   10394  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol	ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
   10395  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
   10396  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook		ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
   10397  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
   10398  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol			ppc_elf_hash_symbol
   10399  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
   10400  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
   10401  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections		ppc_elf_fake_sections
   10402  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers	ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
   10403  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map		ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
   10404  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus		ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
   10405  1.3  christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo			ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
   10406  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note		ppc_elf_write_core_note
   10407  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class		ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
   10408  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing	ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
   10409  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	ppc_elf_final_write_processing
   10410  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_write_section		ppc_elf_write_section
   10411  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr		ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
   10412  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val			ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
   10413  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded		ppc_elf_action_discarded
   10414  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section		_bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
   10415  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook	ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
   10416  1.1  christos 
   10417  1.1  christos #include "elf32-target.h"
   10418  1.1  christos 
   10419  1.1  christos /* FreeBSD Target */
   10420  1.1  christos 
   10421  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10422  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10423  1.3  christos 
   10424  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10425  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM  powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
   10426  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10427  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
   10428  1.1  christos 
   10429  1.1  christos #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10430  1.1  christos #define ELF_OSABI	ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
   10431  1.7  christos 
   10432  1.1  christos #undef  elf32_bed
   10433  1.1  christos #define elf32_bed	elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
   10434  1.1  christos 
   10435  1.1  christos #include "elf32-target.h"
   10436  1.1  christos 
   10437  1.1  christos /* VxWorks Target */
   10438  1.1  christos 
   10439  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10440  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10441  1.1  christos 
   10442  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10443  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
   10444  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10445  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
   10446  1.1  christos 
   10447  1.1  christos #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10448  1.1  christos 
   10449  1.1  christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt.  */
   10450  1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   10451  1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   10452  1.1  christos {
   10453  1.8  christos   if (sec->name == NULL)
   10454  1.1  christos     return NULL;
   10455  1.1  christos 
   10456  1.1  christos   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
   10457  1.1  christos     return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10458  1.1  christos 
   10459  1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10460  1.1  christos }
   10461  1.1  christos 
   10462  1.1  christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
   10463  1.1  christos    appropriately for VxWorks.  */
   10464  1.1  christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   10465  1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   10466  1.1  christos {
   10467  1.1  christos   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
   10468  1.7  christos 
   10469  1.7  christos   ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
   10470  1.1  christos   if (ret)
   10471  1.1  christos     {
   10472  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
   10473  1.7  christos 	= (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
   10474  1.7  christos       htab->is_vxworks = 1;
   10475  1.1  christos       htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
   10476  1.1  christos       htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10477  1.7  christos       htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10478  1.1  christos       htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10479  1.1  christos     }
   10480  1.1  christos   return ret;
   10481  1.1  christos }
   10482  1.1  christos 
   10483  1.7  christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded.  */
   10484  1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   10485  1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   10486  1.1  christos 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   10487  1.1  christos 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   10488  1.1  christos 				 const char **namep,
   10489  1.1  christos 				 flagword *flagsp,
   10490  1.1  christos 				 asection **secp,
   10491  1.1  christos 				 bfd_vma *valp)
   10492  1.1  christos {
   10493  1.1  christos   if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
   10494  1.1  christos 				    valp))
   10495  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   10496  1.1  christos 
   10497  1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
   10498  1.1  christos }
   10499  1.1  christos 
   10500  1.1  christos static void
   10501  1.7  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker)
   10502  1.7  christos {
   10503  1.1  christos   ppc_elf_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
   10504  1.1  christos   elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
   10505  1.1  christos }
   10506  1.1  christos 
   10507  1.1  christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
   10508  1.1  christos    define it.  */
   10509  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
   10510  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym		1
   10511  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
   10512  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt		1
   10513  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
   10514  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset		0
   10515  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
   10516  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded		0
   10517  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
   10518  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly		1
   10519  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
   10520  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size		12
   10521  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
   10522  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt		1
   10523  1.1  christos 
   10524  1.1  christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
   10525  1.1  christos 
   10526  1.1  christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
   10527  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
   10528  1.1  christos   ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
   10529  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
   10530                #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
   10531                  ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
   10532                #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
   10533                #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
   10534                  elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
   10535                #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
   10536                #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
   10537                  ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
   10538                #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
   10539                #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
   10540                  ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
   10541                #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
   10542                #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
   10543                  elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
   10544                
   10545                #undef elf32_bed
   10546                #define elf32_bed				ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
   10547                #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
   10548                
   10549                #include "elf32-target.h"
   10550